Netgear 48xgbe, 4xsfp shared, smart switch, static routing, ipv6, lags, gs748t-500eus

Produkt Netgear 48xgbe, 4xsfp shared, smart switch, static routing, ipv6, lags, gs748t-500eus sme našli 50+x, pokiaľ to nie je to čo hľadáte, skúste frázu Netgear 48xgbe, 4xsfp shared, smart switch, static routing, ipv6, lags, gs748t-500eus upraviť a produkt hľadať znova.

Netgear 48xGbE, 4xSFP shared, SMART SWITCH, static routing, IPv6, LAGs, GS748T-500EUS

Netgear 48xGbE, 4xSFP shared, SMART SWITCH, static routing, IPv6, LAGs, GS748T-500EUS
Detail

GS748Tv5 Standalone Smart Managed Pro Switch Odkaz na web výrobce: Funkce NETGEAR Smart Managed Switches nabízí výkonné funkce L2 a L2 + / Layer 3 Lite, lepší funkčnost PoE a vylepšený výkon. Jsou účelně navrženy pro konvergované sítě, kde jsou všechny audio data, video data a ostatní data přenášeny na jediné síťové platformě. Tyto switche jsou optimalizovány pro efektivitu sítě, úsporu provozních nákladů a snadnou správu. Tato řada switchů nabízí konfigurace 8 až 52 portů jak Fast Ethernetu, tak Gigabit Ethernetu s možnostmi PoE. Všechny switche jsou dodávány s Gigabit SFP porty. Tyto switche jsou ideálním řešením pro firmy, které hledají nejlepší kombinaci funkcí, výkonu a ceny. OBSAH BALENÍ *ProSAFE® Gigabit Smart Managed Switch *Power cord *Rack-mounting kit *Resource CD SPECIFIKACE Technické vlastnosti 10/100Mbps ports *N/A Gigabit ports *48 SFP ports *4 SFP: 2 combo, 2 dedicated Number of PoE ports *N/A PoE+ (802.3at) *N/A Total PoE Power budget (Watts) *N/A Max MAC entries *16K Buffer size *2MB VLAN (Number Supported) *256 VLAN routing *Yes Dynamic VLAN assignment *Yes MLD Snooping *Yes Static route *Yes Host ARP table *512 EEE *Yes DoS Prevention *Yes Internal/External *Internal 100-240VAC 50-60Hz Max consumption (Watts) *41,1 FAN *2 Acoustic Noise Level @25C (dBA) *37.2 dBA Operating Temperature *0° to 50° C MTBF *390,728 hours Weight (kg) *3,46 Dimensions (WxDxH) mm *440x257x43 Pro více informací navštivte web výrobce. V sekci „Download“ naleznete datasheet. (patro.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Netgear 48xGbE, 4xSFP shared, SMART SWITCH, static routing, IPv6, LAGs, GS748T-500EUS , Gosund smart switch sw9 (sw9)

Netgear 24xGbE, 2xSFP shared, SMART SWITCH, static routing, IPv6, LAGs, GS724T-400EUS

Netgear 24xGbE, 2xSFP shared, SMART SWITCH, static routing, IPv6, LAGs, GS724T-400EUS
Detail

GS724Tv4 Standalone Smart Managed Pro Switch Odkaz na web výrobce: Funkce NETGEAR Smart Managed Switches nabízí výkonné funkce L2 a L2 + / Layer 3 Lite, lepší funkčnost PoE a vylepšený výkon. Jsou účelně navrženy pro konvergované sítě, kde jsou všechny audio data, video data a ostatní data přenášeny na jediné síťové platformě. Tyto switche jsou optimalizovány pro efektivitu sítě, úsporu provozních nákladů a snadnou správu. Tato řada switchů nabízí konfigurace 8 až 52 portů jak Fast Ethernetu, tak Gigabit Ethernetu s možnostmi PoE. Všechny switche jsou dodávány s Gigabit SFP porty. Tyto switche jsou ideálním řešením pro firmy, které hledají nejlepší kombinaci funkcí, výkonu a ceny. OBSAH BALENÍ *ProSAFE® Gigabit Smart Managed Switch *Power cord *Rack-mounting kit *Resource CD SPECIFIKACE Technické vlastnosti 10/100Mbps ports *N/A Gigabit ports *24 SFP ports *2 dedicated Number of PoE ports *N/A PoE+ (802.3at) *N/A Total PoE Power budget (Watts) *N/A Max MAC entries *16K Buffer size *2MB VLAN (Number Supported) *256 VLAN routing *Yes Dynamic VLAN assignment *Yes MLD Snooping *Yes Static route *Yes Host ARP table *512 EEE *Yes DoS Prevention *Yes Internal/External *Internal 100-240VAC 50-60Hz Max consumption (Watts) *17,4 FAN *0 Acoustic Noise Level @25C (dBA) *0 dBA Operating Temperature *0° to 50° C MTBF *567,680 hours Weight (kg) *2,74 Dimensions (WxDxH) mm *440x204x43 Pro více informací navštivte web výrobce. V sekci „Download“ naleznete datasheet. (patro.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Netgear 24xGbE, 2xSFP shared, SMART SWITCH, static routing, IPv6, LAGs, GS724T-400EUS , Naturehike ultralight shared 2 20d (6927595749074)

Cisco switch CBS220-48T-4X (48xGbE, 4xSFP+)

Cisco switch CBS220-48T-4X (48xGbE, 4xSFP+)
Detail

Cisco switch CBS220-48T-4X Řada Cisco Business 220 jsou jednoduché a cenově dostupné chytré switche pro sítě podnikové třídy. Díky podpoře mobilních aplikací, nástroji Cisco Business Dashboard a několika možnostem PoE+ poskytuje CBS220 robustní síť v rámci omezeného rozpočtu. Stránky produktu: CBS220-48T-4X Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacityForwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 130,94 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 176 Layer 2 switchingMAC table Up to 8,192 Media Access Control (MAC) addresses Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support, enabled by default Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]) Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP) 16 instances are supported Port grouping Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation Load balance based on source and destination MAC address, or source and destination MAC/IP VLAN Support for up to 256 Virtual Local Area Networks (VLANs) simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Auto voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS QinQ VLAN VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Jumbo frame Frame sizes up to 9,216 supported Loopback detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Automatic Media-Dependent Interface Crossover (MDIX) Automatically adjusts transmit and receive pairs if an incorrect cable type (crossover or straight-through) is installed. SecurityACLs Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IP address, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol (TCP)/ User Datagram Protocol (UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) packets, TCP flag Support up to 512 rules Port security Creates the ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports; limits the number of learned MAC addresses IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-in User Service (RADIUS) authentication; guest VLAN; Single-host, multiple-host, and multisession mode RADIUS, TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and Terminal Access Controller Access Control System (TACACS) authentication; switch functions as a client MAC address filtering Supported Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS protection DOS attack prevention STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard This security mechanism protects the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. Spanning Tree Loop Guard This feature provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops). Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. SCP also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues per port Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port-based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence, Type of Service (ToS), and DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow-based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization. MulticastInternet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) Versions 1, 2, and 3 Snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 256 multicast groups IGMP querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad LACP, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, Request for Comments (RFC) 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 922, RFC 920, RFC 950, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1350, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1624, RFC 1700, RFC 1867, RFC 2030, RFC 2616, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 2576, RFC 4330, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1573, RFC 1643, RFC 1757, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2233, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 1157, RFC 1493, RFC 1215, RFC 3416 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) ICMP version 6 IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) Snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, Cisco Discovery Protocol (CDP), Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) IPv6 Requests for Comments (RFCs) supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463) - ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513) - IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291 - IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460 - IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461) - Neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462) - IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration RFC 1981 - Path MTU discovery RFC 4007 - IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484 - Default address selection mechanism ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support direct management with Cisco Business Dashboard and mobile app. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a zero touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Command-line interface Scriptable CLI; a full CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1 and 15 are supported for the CLI SNMP Simple Management Network Protocol (SNMP) versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Standard Management Information Bases (MIBs) MIB-II (RFC1213) IF-MIB (RFC2863) Bridge-MIB (RFC4188) Bridge-MIB-Extension (RFC2674) RMON (RFC2819) Etherlike MIB (RFC3635) Radius Client MIB (RFC2618) Entity MIB (RFC2737) POWER-ETHERNET-MIB (RFC3621) Syslog MIB (RFC3164) Generic Traps MIB (RFC1215) SNMP-COMMUNITY-MIB SNMP-MIB LLDP-MIB LLDP-EXT-MED-MIB IEEE8023-LAG-MIB CISCO-PORT-SECURITY-MIB CISCO-ENVMON-MIB CISCO-CDP-MIB CISCO-CONFIG-COPY-MIB Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED Extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones. Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. Displays brief information for connected Cisco network devices, IP phones, and wireless access points Power efficiencyEEE compliance (802.3az) Support 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet on all ports; substantially reduce the power consumption when link bandwidth is not at full utilization Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on Gigabit Ethernet and 10/100 RJ-45 ports when detecting a link down Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy. Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up). HardwareButtons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5 or better for 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX; UTP Category 5 Ethernet or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, Speed Flash 64 MB CPU memory 256 MB PortsTotal system ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet, 4 10 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet Uplink ports 4 10G SFP+ Packet BufferPacket buffer 16 Mb Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e SFP-H10GB-CU1M Copper coax SFP-10G-SR Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR Single-mode fiber SFP-10G-SR-S Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR-S Single-mode fiber EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 440 x 257 x 44 mm (17.3 x 10.1 x 1.7 in) Unit weight 3.54 kg (7.80 lb) Power 100-240 V, 50-60 Hz, Internal Certifications UL (UL 60950), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A, C-tick Operating temperature 0-50° C Storage temperature –20° C to +70° C Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=41.0W 220V=41.2W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 140.58 Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C: 32,6 dB MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 420827 Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 220 Series Ethernet switch Power cord or adaptor Mounting kit Quick start guide (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS220-48T-4X (48xGbE, 4xSFP+) , Sonoff zigbee smart switch, zbmini (zbmini)

Cisco switch CBS250-48T-4X (48xGbE, 4xSFP+)

Cisco switch CBS250-48T-4X (48xGbE, 4xSFP+)
Detail

Cisco switch CBS250-48T-4X Řada Cisco Business 250 představuje novou generaci cenově dostupných inteligentních switchů, které kombinují vysoký síťový výkon, zabezpečení a spolehlivost s komplexní sadou síťových funkcí potřebných pro spolehlivou síť malých firem. Záruka platná do End of Support 31. 10. 2029. Oznámení End of Life pro CISCO CBS250 Stránky produktu: CBS250-48T-4X Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity (All switches are wire-speed and nonblocking)Forwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 130,94 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 176 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d spanning tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple spanning tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+); 126 instances are supported Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 4 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad Link Aggregation Group (LAG) VLAN Support for up to 255 active VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers networkwide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain IGMP (versions 1, 2, and 3) snooping Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 255 multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP querier Used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router HOL blocking Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking prevention Loopback detection Provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Layer 3 routingIPv4 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 32 static routes and up to 16 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, LAG, VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for CIDR Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BootP)/DHCP packets SecuritySecure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication, guest VLAN, single/multiple host mode, and single/multiple sessions STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) Secure Core Technology (SCT) Ensures that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plain text or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limit the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS Supports RADIUS authentication for management access. Switch functions as a client. Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DoS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels Access Control Lists (ACLs) Support for up to 512 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, TCP/UDP source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.3 ad LACP, IEEE 802.1D (STP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 Neighbor Discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) version 6 IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, Ping, Traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP), Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS), Syslog, DNS client, DHCP client, DHCP autoconfig IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC 2463): ICMPv6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 Addressing Architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 Specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): Neighbor Discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 Stateless Address Autoconfiguration RFC 1981: Path MTU Discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 Scoped Address Architecture RFC 3484: Default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: Management Information Base (MIB) IPv6: Textual Conventions and General Group RFC 3595: Textual Conventions for IPv6 Flow Label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, wizards, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Basic and advanced mode for maximum operational efficiency SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP v3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server), to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP Relay, and host name Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfers files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with SCP file download Enables mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable configs Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Automatically applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartports roles to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments. Text view Command-Line Interface (CLI) Scriptable CLI. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI. Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP); cable diagnostics; Ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link is up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables EEE compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 8K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics using Cisco Discovery Protocol Hardware Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=51.01W 220V=50.58W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 174.06 PortsTotal system ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet + 4 10 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 4 SFP+ Console port Cisco Standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer 3 MB Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e SFP-H10GB-CU1M Copper coax SFP-H10GB-CU3M Copper coax SFP-H10GB-CU5M Copper coax SFP-10G-SR Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR Single-mode fiber SFP-10G-SR-S Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR-S Single-mode fiber EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 445 x 288 x 44 mm (17.5 x 11.33 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 3.95 kg (8.71 lb) Power 100 to 240V 50 to 60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C) Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C: 29.7 dBA MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 1452667 Warranty Limited lifetime Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 250 Series Smart Switch Power cord Mounting kit Quick start guide (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS250-48T-4X (48xGbE, 4xSFP+) , Tesla smart switch (tsl-swi-wifi1)

Cisco switch CBS220-48T-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP)

Cisco switch CBS220-48T-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP)
Detail

Cisco switch CBS220-48T-4G Řada Cisco Business 220 jsou jednoduché a cenově dostupné chytré switche pro sítě podnikové třídy. Díky podpoře mobilních aplikací, nástroji Cisco Business Dashboard a několika možnostem PoE+ poskytuje CBS220 robustní síť v rámci omezeného rozpočtu. Stránky produktu: CBS220-48T-4G Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacityForwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 74,38 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 104 Layer 2 switchingMAC table Up to 8,192 Media Access Control (MAC) addresses Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support, enabled by default Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]) Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP) 16 instances are supported Port grouping Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation Load balance based on source and destination MAC address, or source and destination MAC/IP VLAN Support for up to 256 Virtual Local Area Networks (VLANs) simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Auto voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS QinQ VLAN VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Jumbo frame Frame sizes up to 9,216 supported Loopback detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Automatic Media-Dependent Interface Crossover (MDIX) Automatically adjusts transmit and receive pairs if an incorrect cable type (crossover or straight-through) is installed. SecurityACLs Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IP address, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol (TCP)/ User Datagram Protocol (UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) packets, TCP flag Support up to 512 rules Port security Creates the ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports; limits the number of learned MAC addresses IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-in User Service (RADIUS) authentication; guest VLAN; Single-host, multiple-host, and multisession mode RADIUS, TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and Terminal Access Controller Access Control System (TACACS) authentication; switch functions as a client MAC address filtering Supported Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS protection DOS attack prevention STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard This security mechanism protects the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. Spanning Tree Loop Guard This feature provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops). Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. SCP also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues per port Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port-based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence, Type of Service (ToS), and DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow-based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization. MulticastInternet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) Versions 1, 2, and 3 Snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 256 multicast groups IGMP querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad LACP, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, Request for Comments (RFC) 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 922, RFC 920, RFC 950, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1350, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1624, RFC 1700, RFC 1867, RFC 2030, RFC 2616, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 2576, RFC 4330, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1573, RFC 1643, RFC 1757, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2233, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 1157, RFC 1493, RFC 1215, RFC 3416 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) ICMP version 6 IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) Snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, Cisco Discovery Protocol (CDP), Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) IPv6 Requests for Comments (RFCs) supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463) - ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513) - IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291 - IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460 - IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461) - Neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462) - IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration RFC 1981 - Path MTU discovery RFC 4007 - IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484 - Default address selection mechanism ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support direct management with Cisco Business Dashboard and mobile app. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a zero touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Command-line interface Scriptable CLI; a full CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1 and 15 are supported for the CLI SNMP Simple Management Network Protocol (SNMP) versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Standard Management Information Bases (MIBs) MIB-II (RFC1213) IF-MIB (RFC2863) Bridge-MIB (RFC4188) Bridge-MIB-Extension (RFC2674) RMON (RFC2819) Etherlike MIB (RFC3635) Radius Client MIB (RFC2618) Entity MIB (RFC2737) POWER-ETHERNET-MIB (RFC3621) Syslog MIB (RFC3164) Generic Traps MIB (RFC1215) SNMP-COMMUNITY-MIB SNMP-MIB LLDP-MIB LLDP-EXT-MED-MIB IEEE8023-LAG-MIB CISCO-PORT-SECURITY-MIB CISCO-ENVMON-MIB CISCO-CDP-MIB CISCO-CONFIG-COPY-MIB Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED Extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones. Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. Displays brief information for connected Cisco network devices, IP phones, and wireless access points Power efficiencyEEE compliance (802.3az) Support 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet on all ports; substantially reduce the power consumption when link bandwidth is not at full utilization Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on Gigabit Ethernet and 10/100 RJ-45 ports when detecting a link down Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy. Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up). HardwareButtons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5 or better for 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX; UTP Category 5 Ethernet or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, Speed Flash 64 MB CPU memory 256 MB PortsTotal system ports 52 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet Uplink ports 4 Gigabit Ethernet Small form-factor pluggable (SFP) Packet BufferPacket buffer 12 Mb Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 440 x 257 x 44 mm (17.3 x 10.1 x 1.7 in) Unit weight 3.18 kg (7.01 lb) Power 100-240 V, 50-60 Hz, Internal Certifications UL (UL 60950), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A, C-tick Operating temperature 0-50° C Storage temperature –20° C to +70° C Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=36.5W 220V=36.1W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 124.54 Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C: 35.0 dB MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 727181 Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 220 Series Ethernet switch Power cord or adaptor Mounting kit Quick start guide (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS220-48T-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP) , Tesla smart switch dual (tsl-swi-wifi2)

Cisco switch CBS250-48T-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP)

Cisco switch CBS250-48T-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP)
Detail

Cisco switch CBS250-48T-4G Řada Cisco Business 250 představuje novou generaci cenově dostupných inteligentních switchů, které kombinují vysoký síťový výkon, zabezpečení a spolehlivost s komplexní sadou síťových funkcí potřebných pro spolehlivou síť malých firem. Záruka platná do End of Support 31. 10. 2029. Oznámení End of Life pro CISCO CBS250 Stránky produktu: CBS250-48T-4G Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity (All switches are wire-speed and nonblocking)Forwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 77,38 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 104 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d spanning tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple spanning tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+); 126 instances are supported Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 4 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad Link Aggregation Group (LAG) VLAN Support for up to 255 active VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers networkwide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain IGMP (versions 1, 2, and 3) snooping Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 255 multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP querier Used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router HOL blocking Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking prevention Loopback detection Provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Layer 3 routingIPv4 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 32 static routes and up to 16 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, LAG, VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for CIDR Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BootP)/DHCP packets SecuritySecure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication, guest VLAN, single/multiple host mode, and single/multiple sessions STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) Secure Core Technology (SCT) Ensures that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plain text or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limit the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS Supports RADIUS authentication for management access. Switch functions as a client. Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DoS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels Access Control Lists (ACLs) Support for up to 512 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, TCP/UDP source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.3 ad LACP, IEEE 802.1D (STP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 Neighbor Discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) version 6 IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, Ping, Traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP), Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS), Syslog, DNS client, DHCP client, DHCP autoconfig IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC 2463): ICMPv6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 Addressing Architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 Specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): Neighbor Discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 Stateless Address Autoconfiguration RFC 1981: Path MTU Discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 Scoped Address Architecture RFC 3484: Default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: Management Information Base (MIB) IPv6: Textual Conventions and General Group RFC 3595: Textual Conventions for IPv6 Flow Label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, wizards, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Basic and advanced mode for maximum operational efficiency SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP v3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server), to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP Relay, and host name Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfers files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with SCP file download Enables mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable configs Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Automatically applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartports roles to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments. Text view Command-Line Interface (CLI) Scriptable CLI. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI. Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP); cable diagnostics; Ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link is up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables EEE compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 8K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics using Cisco Discovery Protocol Hardware Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=48.27W 220V=48.64W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 165.96 PortsTotal system ports 52 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 4 SFP Console port Cisco Standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer 3 MB Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 445 x 288 x 44 mm (17.5 x 11.33 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 3.95 kg (8.71 lb) Power 100 to 240V 50 to 60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C) Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C: 29.7 dBA MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 1452667 Warranty Limited lifetime Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 250 Series Smart Switch Power cord Mounting kit Quick start guide (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS250-48T-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP) , Tellur wifi smart inline switch, 2200w, bílý

Cisco switch CBS250-48T-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP) - REFRESH

Cisco switch CBS250-48T-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP) - REFRESH
Detail

Cisco switch CBS250-48T-4G - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu Řada Cisco Business 250 představuje novou generaci cenově dostupných inteligentních switchů, které kombinují vysoký síťový výkon, zabezpečení a spolehlivost s komplexní sadou síťových funkcí potřebných pro spolehlivou síť malých firem. Záruka platná do End of Support 31. 10. 2029. Oznámení End of Life pro CISCO CBS250 Stránky produktu: CBS250-48T-4G Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity (All switches are wire-speed and nonblocking)Forwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 77,38 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 104 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d spanning tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple spanning tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+); 126 instances are supported Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 4 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad Link Aggregation Group (LAG) VLAN Support for up to 255 active VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers networkwide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain IGMP (versions 1, 2, and 3) snooping Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 255 multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP querier Used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router HOL blocking Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking prevention Loopback detection Provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Layer 3 routingIPv4 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 32 static routes and up to 16 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, LAG, VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for CIDR Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BootP)/DHCP packets SecuritySecure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication, guest VLAN, single/multiple host mode, and single/multiple sessions STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) Secure Core Technology (SCT) Ensures that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plain text or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limit the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS Supports RADIUS authentication for management access. Switch functions as a client. Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DoS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels Access Control Lists (ACLs) Support for up to 512 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, TCP/UDP source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.3 ad LACP, IEEE 802.1D (STP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 Neighbor Discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) version 6 IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, Ping, Traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP), Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS), Syslog, DNS client, DHCP client, DHCP autoconfig IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC 2463): ICMPv6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 Addressing Architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 Specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): Neighbor Discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 Stateless Address Autoconfiguration RFC 1981: Path MTU Discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 Scoped Address Architecture RFC 3484: Default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: Management Information Base (MIB) IPv6: Textual Conventions and General Group RFC 3595: Textual Conventions for IPv6 Flow Label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, wizards, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Basic and advanced mode for maximum operational efficiency SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP v3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server), to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP Relay, and host name Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfers files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with SCP file download Enables mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable configs Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Automatically applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartports roles to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments. Text view Command-Line Interface (CLI) Scriptable CLI. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI. Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP); cable diagnostics; Ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link is up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables EEE compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 8K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics using Cisco Discovery Protocol Hardware Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=48.27W 220V=48.64W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 165.96 PortsTotal system ports 52 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 4 SFP Console port Cisco Standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer 3 MB Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 445 x 288 x 44 mm (17.5 x 11.33 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 3.95 kg (8.71 lb) Power 100 to 240V 50 to 60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C) Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C: 29.7 dBA MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 1452667 Warranty Limited lifetime Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 250 Series Smart Switch Power cord Mounting kit Quick start guide (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS250-48T-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP) - REFRESH , Moes smart wifi+rf433 switch (ws-eub1)

Cisco switch CBS250-24T-4X (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, fanless)

Cisco switch CBS250-24T-4X (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, fanless)
Detail

Cisco Switch CBS250-24T-4X EAN: 889728295826 Popis produktu Výkonný a cenově dostupný switch pro malé firmy od firmy Cisco. Výhody Možnost 8 až 48 portů Gigabit Ethernet. GE nebo 10-GE uplink a podpora PoE+. Plug-and-play s hlasovým, bezdrátovými, datovými, video a připojenými síťovými zařízeními. Poskytnutí dalšího optického připojení pro vyšší šířku pásma pro uplink a rozšířené možnosti pro napájení přes PoE. Integrované zabezpečení chránící Vaše obchodní data před neoprávněným přístupem. Technické specifikace Počet portů: 28 Provedení: Rack-mount Porty: 24 x GbE RJ45, 4 x 10GbE SFP+ Výkon: Switching capacity: 128.0 Gbps, Forwarding performance (64-byte packet size): 95.23 Mpps VLAN: Ano Protokol pro vzdálenou správu: SNMP, RMON, HTTP, HTTPS, TFTP, Telnet, SSH Standardy IEEE 802.3, IEEE 802.3u, IEEE 802.3ab, IEEE 802.3ad, IEEE 802.3z, IEEE 802.3x, IEEE 802.3 ad LACP, IEEE 802.1D, IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w, IEEE 802.1s, IEEE 802.1X, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at Velikost MAC tabulky: 8 000 RAM: 512 MB Flash: 256 MB Napájení: 100-240 V (50-60 Hz), interní Rozměry (Š x V x H): 445 x 240 x 44 mm Hmotnost: 2.78 kg Provozní teplota: -5 až 50°C Provozní vlhost: 10 - 90% Skladovací teplota: -25 až 70 °C (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS250-24T-4X (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, fanless) , Tesla smart switch zigbee (tsl-swi-zigbee1)

Cisco switch CBS350-48T-4G-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP)

Cisco switch CBS350-48T-4G-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP)
Detail

Cisco switch CBS350-48T-4G-EU Řízené switche řady Cisco Business 350 jsou spolehlivými stavebními prvky pro sítě malých firem. Díky intuitivnímu ovládacímu panelu, pokročilým funkcím a všudypřítomnému zabezpečení urychlují spravované switche řady Cisco Business 350 vaši digitální transformaci. Záruka platná do End of Support 31. 10. 2029. Oznámení End of Life pro CISCO CBS350 Stránky produktu: CBS350-48T-4G-EU Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity and forwarding rate (All switches are wire speed and nonblocking)Capacity in Millions of Packets per Second (mpps) (64-byte packets) 77,38 Switching Capacity in Gigabits per Second (Gbps) 104 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+) and Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation VLAN Support for up to 4,094 VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs; MAC-based VLAN; protocol-based VLAN; IP subnet-based VLAN Management VLAN Private VLAN with promiscuous, isolated, and community port Private VLAN Edge (PVE), also known as protected ports, with multiple uplinks Guest VLAN, unauthenticated VLAN Dynamic VLAN assignment via RADIUS server along with 802.1x client authentication CPE VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers network wide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Multicast TV VLAN Multicast TV VLAN allows the single multicast VLAN to be shared in the network while subscribers remain in separate VLANs. This feature is also known as Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR) VLAN Translation Support for VLAN One-to-One Mapping. In VLAN One-to-One Mapping, on an edge interface customer VLANs (C-VLANs) are mapped to service provider VLANs (S-VLANs) and the original C-VLAN tags are replaced by the specified S-VLAN Q-in-Q VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Selective Q-in-Q Selective Q-in-Q is an enhancement to the basic Q-in-Q feature and provides, per edge interface, multiple mappings of different C-VLANs to separate S-VLANs Selective Q-in-Q also allows configuring of Ethertype (Tag Protocol Identifier [TPID]) of the S-VLAN tag Layer 2 protocol tunneling over Q-in-Q is also supported Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP)/Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) enable automatic propagation and configuration of VLANs in a bridged domain Unidirectional Link Detection (UDLD) UDLD monitors physical connection to detect unidirectional links caused by incorrect wiring or cable/port faults to prevent forwarding loops and black holing of traffic in switched networks Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) Relay at Layer 2 Relay of DHCP traffic to DHCP server in different VLAN; works with DHCP Option 82 Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) versions 1, 2, and 3 snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 2K multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP Querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router IGMP proxy The IGMP proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on IGMP membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Loopback Detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP Layer 3IPv4 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 990 static routes and up to 128 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 Interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, Link Aggregation (LAG), VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for classless interdomain routing RIP v2 Support for Routing Information Protocol version 2 for dynamic routing Policy-Based Routing (PBR) Flexible routing control to direct packets to different next hop based on IPv4 or IPv6 Access Control List (ACL) DHCP Server Switch functions as an IPv4 DHCP server serving IP addresses for multiple DHCP pools/scopes Support for DHCP options DHCP relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP)/DHCP packets Securityecure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy Protocol (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch IEEE 802.1X (Authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication and accounting, MD5 hash; guest VLAN; unauthenticated VLAN, single/multiple host mode and single/multiple sessions Supports time-based 802.1X; dynamic VLAN assignment; MAC authentication IEEE 802.1X supplicant A switch can be configured to act as a supplicant to another switch. This enables extended secure access in areas outside the wiring closet (such as conference rooms) Web-based authentication Web-based authentication provides network admission control through web browser to any host devices and operating systems STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard A security mechanism to protect the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. This avoids accidental topology loops STP Root Guard This prevents edge devices not in the network administrator’s control from becoming Spanning Tree Protocol root nodes STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) DHCP snooping Filters out DHCP messages with unregistered IP addresses and/or from unexpected or untrusted interfaces. This prevents rogue devices from behaving as DHCP Servers. IP Source Guard (IPSG) When IP Source Guard is enabled at a port, the switch filters out IP packets received from the port if the source IP addresses of the packets have not been statically configured or dynamically learned from DHCP snooping. This prevents IP address spoofing. Dynamic ARP Inspection (DAI) The switch discards ARP packets from a port if there are no static or dynamic IP/MAC bindings or if there is a discrepancy between the source or destination addresses in the ARP packet. This prevents man-in-the-middle attacks. IP/MAC/Port Binding (IPMB) The preceding features (DHCP Snooping, IP Source Guard, and Dynamic ARP Inspection) work together to prevent DOS attacks in the network, thereby increasing network availability Secure Core Technology (SCT) Makes sure that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plaintext or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user. Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Private VLAN Private VLAN provides security and isolation between switch ports, which helps ensure that users cannot snoop on other users’ traffic; supports multiple uplinks Layer 2 isolation Private VLAN Edge (PVE) PVE (also known as protected ports) provides Layer 2 isolation between devices in the same VLAN, supports multiple uplinks Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limits the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS/TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and TACACS authentication. Switch functions as a client RADIUS accounting The RADIUS accounting functions allow data to be sent at the start and end of services, indicating the amount of resources (such as time, packets, bytes, and so on) used during the session Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DOS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels ACLs Support for up to 1,024 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID, IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol/User Datagram Protocol (TCP/UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported Quality of ServicePriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and remarking ACLs, trusted QoS Queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based; 2R3C policing Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to minimize and prevent global TCP loss synchronization iSCSI traffic optimization A mechanism for giving priority to iSCSI traffic over other types of traffic Standards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ae 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over fiber for LAN, IEEE 802.3an 10GBase-T 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over copper twisted pair cable, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w Rapid STP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, IEEE 802.1AB Link Layer Discovery Protocol, IEEE 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 826, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3176, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode; IPv6 over Ethernet; Dual IPv6/IPv4 stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND); IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration; Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD); ICMP version 6 DHCPv6 stateful client IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) tunnel support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 First Hop Security RA guard ND inspection DHCPv6 guard Neighbor binding table (snooping and static entries) Neighbor binding integrity check Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers MLD proxy The MLD proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on MLD membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, ping, traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), SNMP, RADIUS, syslog, Domain Name System (DNS) client, Telnet Client, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, IPv6 DHCP Relay, Terminal Access Controller Access Control System Plus (TACACS+) IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463): ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration RFC 1981: path MTU discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484: default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: MIB IPv6: textual conventions and general group RFC 3595: textual conventions for IPv6 flow label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports simple and advanced mode, configuration, wizards, customizable dashboard, system maintenance, monitoring, online help, and universal search SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port. Flow-based redirection and mirroring Redirect or mirror traffic to a destination port or mirroring session based on flow Remote Switch Port Analyzer (RSPAN) Traffic can be mirrored across Layer 2 domain to a remote port on a different switch for easier troubleshooting sFlow agent Switch can export sFlow sample to external collectors. sFlow provides visibility into network traffic down to flow level DHCP (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 82, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfer files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with Secure Copy (SCP) file download Enables secure mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartport roles and applies it automatically to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments Textview CLI Scriptable command-line interface. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; SSH; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; BOOTP; SNTP; Xmodem upgrade; cable diagnostics; ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables. EEE Compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 16K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics via Cisco Discovery Protocol Hardware Power Consumption (worst case)System power consumption 110V=48.27W 220V=48.64 Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 165,96 PortsTotal system ports 52 x Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 48 x Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 4 x SFP Console port Cisco standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer (All numbers are aggregate across all ports as the buffers are dynamically shared:) 3 MB Supported SFP modulesSKU Media MGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP cat 5e GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 445 x 288 x 44 mm (17.5 x 11.33 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 3.95 kg (8.71 lb) Power 100-240V 50-60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C) Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C: 29.7 dBA MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 1452667 Warranty Limited lifetime with next business day advance replacement Package contents Cisco Business 350 Series Managed Switch Power cord Mounting Kit Quick Start Guide Minimum Requirements Web browser: Chrome, Firefox, Edge, Safari Category 5e Ethernet network cable TCP/IP, network adapter, and network operating system (such as Microsoft Windows, Linux, or Mac OS X) installed (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS350-48T-4G-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP) , Aveli static wings (xrt-00069)

Cisco switch CBS350-48T-4X-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP+)

Cisco switch CBS350-48T-4X-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP+)
Detail

Cisco switch CBS350-48T-4X-EU Řízené switche řady Cisco Business 350 jsou spolehlivými stavebními prvky pro sítě malých firem. Díky intuitivnímu ovládacímu panelu, pokročilým funkcím a všudypřítomnému zabezpečení urychlují spravované switche řady Cisco Business 350 vaši digitální transformaci. Záruka platná do End of Support 31. 10. 2029. Oznámení End of Life pro CISCO CBS350 Stránky produktu: CBS350-48T-4X-EU Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity and forwarding rate (All switches are wire speed and nonblocking)Capacity in Millions of Packets per Second (mpps) (64-byte packets) 130,94 Switching Capacity in Gigabits per Second (Gbps) 176 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+) and Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation VLAN Support for up to 4,094 VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs; MAC-based VLAN; protocol-based VLAN; IP subnet-based VLAN Management VLAN Private VLAN with promiscuous, isolated, and community port Private VLAN Edge (PVE), also known as protected ports, with multiple uplinks Guest VLAN, unauthenticated VLAN Dynamic VLAN assignment via RADIUS server along with 802.1x client authentication CPE VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers network wide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Multicast TV VLAN Multicast TV VLAN allows the single multicast VLAN to be shared in the network while subscribers remain in separate VLANs. This feature is also known as Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR) VLAN Translation Support for VLAN One-to-One Mapping. In VLAN One-to-One Mapping, on an edge interface customer VLANs (C-VLANs) are mapped to service provider VLANs (S-VLANs) and the original C-VLAN tags are replaced by the specified S-VLAN Q-in-Q VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Selective Q-in-Q Selective Q-in-Q is an enhancement to the basic Q-in-Q feature and provides, per edge interface, multiple mappings of different C-VLANs to separate S-VLANs Selective Q-in-Q also allows configuring of Ethertype (Tag Protocol Identifier [TPID]) of the S-VLAN tag Layer 2 protocol tunneling over Q-in-Q is also supported Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP)/Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) enable automatic propagation and configuration of VLANs in a bridged domain Unidirectional Link Detection (UDLD) UDLD monitors physical connection to detect unidirectional links caused by incorrect wiring or cable/port faults to prevent forwarding loops and black holing of traffic in switched networks Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) Relay at Layer 2 Relay of DHCP traffic to DHCP server in different VLAN; works with DHCP Option 82 Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) versions 1, 2, and 3 snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 2K multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP Querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router IGMP proxy The IGMP proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on IGMP membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Loopback Detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP Layer 3IPv4 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 990 static routes and up to 128 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 Interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, Link Aggregation (LAG), VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for classless interdomain routing RIP v2 Support for Routing Information Protocol version 2 for dynamic routing Policy-Based Routing (PBR) Flexible routing control to direct packets to different next hop based on IPv4 or IPv6 Access Control List (ACL) DHCP Server Switch functions as an IPv4 DHCP server serving IP addresses for multiple DHCP pools/scopes Support for DHCP options DHCP relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP)/DHCP packets StackingHardware stacking Up to 4 units in a stack. Up to 200 ports managed as a single system with hardware failover High availability Fast stack failover delivers minimal traffic loss. Support link aggregation across multiple units in a stack Plug-and-play stacking configuration/management Active/standby for resilient stack control Autonumbering Hot swap of units in stack Ring and chain stacking options, auto stacking port speed, flexible stacking port options High-speed stack interconnects Cost-effective high-speed 10G fiber interfaces. Securityecure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy Protocol (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch IEEE 802.1X (Authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication and accounting, MD5 hash; guest VLAN; unauthenticated VLAN, single/multiple host mode and single/multiple sessions Supports time-based 802.1X; dynamic VLAN assignment; MAC authentication IEEE 802.1X supplicant A switch can be configured to act as a supplicant to another switch. This enables extended secure access in areas outside the wiring closet (such as conference rooms) Web-based authentication Web-based authentication provides network admission control through web browser to any host devices and operating systems STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard A security mechanism to protect the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. This avoids accidental topology loops STP Root Guard This prevents edge devices not in the network administrator’s control from becoming Spanning Tree Protocol root nodes STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) DHCP snooping Filters out DHCP messages with unregistered IP addresses and/or from unexpected or untrusted interfaces. This prevents rogue devices from behaving as DHCP Servers. IP Source Guard (IPSG) When IP Source Guard is enabled at a port, the switch filters out IP packets received from the port if the source IP addresses of the packets have not been statically configured or dynamically learned from DHCP snooping. This prevents IP address spoofing. Dynamic ARP Inspection (DAI) The switch discards ARP packets from a port if there are no static or dynamic IP/MAC bindings or if there is a discrepancy between the source or destination addresses in the ARP packet. This prevents man-in-the-middle attacks. IP/MAC/Port Binding (IPMB) The preceding features (DHCP Snooping, IP Source Guard, and Dynamic ARP Inspection) work together to prevent DOS attacks in the network, thereby increasing network availability Secure Core Technology (SCT) Makes sure that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plaintext or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user. Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Private VLAN Private VLAN provides security and isolation between switch ports, which helps ensure that users cannot snoop on other users’ traffic; supports multiple uplinks Layer 2 isolation Private VLAN Edge (PVE) PVE (also known as protected ports) provides Layer 2 isolation between devices in the same VLAN, supports multiple uplinks Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limits the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS/TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and TACACS authentication. Switch functions as a client RADIUS accounting The RADIUS accounting functions allow data to be sent at the start and end of services, indicating the amount of resources (such as time, packets, bytes, and so on) used during the session Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DOS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels ACLs Support for up to 1,024 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID, IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol/User Datagram Protocol (TCP/UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported Quality of ServicePriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and remarking ACLs, trusted QoS Queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based; 2R3C policing Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to minimize and prevent global TCP loss synchronization iSCSI traffic optimization A mechanism for giving priority to iSCSI traffic over other types of traffic Standards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ae 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over fiber for LAN, IEEE 802.3an 10GBase-T 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over copper twisted pair cable, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w Rapid STP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, IEEE 802.1AB Link Layer Discovery Protocol, IEEE 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 826, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3176, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode; IPv6 over Ethernet; Dual IPv6/IPv4 stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND); IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration; Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD); ICMP version 6 DHCPv6 stateful client IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) tunnel support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 First Hop Security RA guard ND inspection DHCPv6 guard Neighbor binding table (snooping and static entries) Neighbor binding integrity check Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers MLD proxy The MLD proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on MLD membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, ping, traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), SNMP, RADIUS, syslog, Domain Name System (DNS) client, Telnet Client, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, IPv6 DHCP Relay, Terminal Access Controller Access Control System Plus (TACACS+) IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463): ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration RFC 1981: path MTU discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484: default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: MIB IPv6: textual conventions and general group RFC 3595: textual conventions for IPv6 flow label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports simple and advanced mode, configuration, wizards, customizable dashboard, system maintenance, monitoring, online help, and universal search SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port. Flow-based redirection and mirroring Redirect or mirror traffic to a destination port or mirroring session based on flow Remote Switch Port Analyzer (RSPAN) Traffic can be mirrored across Layer 2 domain to a remote port on a different switch for easier troubleshooting sFlow agent Switch can export sFlow sample to external collectors. sFlow provides visibility into network traffic down to flow level DHCP (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 82, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfer files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with Secure Copy (SCP) file download Enables secure mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartport roles and applies it automatically to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments Textview CLI Scriptable command-line interface. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; SSH; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; BOOTP; SNTP; Xmodem upgrade; cable diagnostics; ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables. EEE Compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 16K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics via Cisco Discovery Protocol Hardware Power Consumption (worst case)System power consumption 110V=51.01W 220V=50.58 Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 174,06 PortsTotal system ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet + 4 x 10G RJ-45 ports 48 x Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 4 x SFP+ Console port Cisco standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer (All numbers are aggregate across all ports as the buffers are dynamically shared:) 3 MB Supported SFP modulesSKU Media MGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP cat 5e GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e SFP-H10GB-CU1M Copper coax SFP-H10GB-CU3M Copper coax SFP-H10GB-CU5M Copper coax SFP-10G-SR Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR Single-mode fiber SFP-10G-SR-S Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR-S Single-mode fiber EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 445 x 288 x 44 mm (17.5 x 11.33 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 3.95 kg (8.71 lb) Power 100-240V 50-60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C) Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C: 29.7 dBA MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 1452667 Warranty Limited lifetime with next business day advance replacement Package contents Cisco Business 350 Series Managed Switch Power cord Mounting Kit Quick Start Guide Minimum Requirements Web browser: Chrome, Firefox, Edge, Safari Category 5e Ethernet network cable TCP/IP, network adapter, and network operating system (such as Microsoft Windows, Linux, or Mac OS X) installed (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS350-48T-4X-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP+) , Tesla smart switch dual zigbee (tsl-swi-zigbee2)

Cisco switch CBS250-48P-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 370W)

Cisco switch CBS250-48P-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 370W)
Detail

Cisco switch CBS250-48P-4G Řada Cisco Business 250 představuje novou generaci cenově dostupných inteligentních switchů, které kombinují vysoký síťový výkon, zabezpečení a spolehlivost s komplexní sadou síťových funkcí potřebných pro spolehlivou síť malých firem. Záruka platná do End of Support 31. 10. 2029. Oznámení End of Life pro CISCO CBS250 Stránky produktu: CBS250-48P-4G Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity (All switches are wire-speed and nonblocking)Forwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 77,38 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 104 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d spanning tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple spanning tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+); 126 instances are supported Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 4 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad Link Aggregation Group (LAG) VLAN Support for up to 255 active VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers networkwide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain IGMP (versions 1, 2, and 3) snooping Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 255 multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP querier Used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router HOL blocking Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking prevention Loopback detection Provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Layer 3 routingIPv4 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 32 static routes and up to 16 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, LAG, VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for CIDR Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BootP)/DHCP packets SecuritySecure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication, guest VLAN, single/multiple host mode, and single/multiple sessions STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) Secure Core Technology (SCT) Ensures that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plain text or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limit the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS Supports RADIUS authentication for management access. Switch functions as a client. Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DoS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels Access Control Lists (ACLs) Support for up to 512 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, TCP/UDP source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.3 ad LACP, IEEE 802.1D (STP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 Neighbor Discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) version 6 IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, Ping, Traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP), Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS), Syslog, DNS client, DHCP client, DHCP autoconfig IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC 2463): ICMPv6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 Addressing Architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 Specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): Neighbor Discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 Stateless Address Autoconfiguration RFC 1981: Path MTU Discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 Scoped Address Architecture RFC 3484: Default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: Management Information Base (MIB) IPv6: Textual Conventions and General Group RFC 3595: Textual Conventions for IPv6 Flow Label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, wizards, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Basic and advanced mode for maximum operational efficiency SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP v3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server), to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP Relay, and host name Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfers files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with SCP file download Enables mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable configs Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Automatically applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartports roles to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments. Text view Command-Line Interface (CLI) Scriptable CLI. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI. Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP); cable diagnostics; Ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link is up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables EEE compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 8K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics using Cisco Discovery Protocol Power over Ethernet802.3at PoE+ and 802.3af PoE delivered over any of the RJ-45 ports within the listed power budgets The following switches support 802.3at PoE+, 802.3af, and Cisco prestandard (legacy) PoE. Maximum power of 30.0W to any 10/100 or Gigabit Ethernet port, until the PoE budget for the switch is reached. The total power available for PoE per switch is as follows: Power dedicated to PoE 370 W Number of ports that support PoE 48 Hardware Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=60.77W 220V=59.73W Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=451.95W 220V=445.85W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 1542.12 PortsTotal system ports 52 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 4 SFP Console port Cisco Standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer 3 MB Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 445 x 350 x 44 mm (17.5 x 13.78 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 5.43 kg (11.97 lb) Power 100 to 240V 50 to 60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C: 37.3 dBA MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 856329 Warranty Limited lifetime Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 250 Series Smart Switch Power cord Mounting kit Quick start guide (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS250-48P-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 370W) , Tesla smart switch dual battery (tsl-swi-scenezg2)

Cisco switch CBS250-48PP-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 195W)

Cisco switch CBS250-48PP-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 195W)
Detail

Cisco switch CBS250-48PP-4G Řada Cisco Business 250 představuje novou generaci cenově dostupných inteligentních switchů, které kombinují vysoký síťový výkon, zabezpečení a spolehlivost s komplexní sadou síťových funkcí potřebných pro spolehlivou síť malých firem. Záruka platná do End of Support 31. 10. 2029. Oznámení End of Life pro CISCO CBS250 Stránky produktu: CBS250-48PP-4G Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity (All switches are wire-speed and nonblocking)Forwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 77,38 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 104 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d spanning tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple spanning tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+); 126 instances are supported Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 4 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad Link Aggregation Group (LAG) VLAN Support for up to 255 active VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers networkwide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain IGMP (versions 1, 2, and 3) snooping Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 255 multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP querier Used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router HOL blocking Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking prevention Loopback detection Provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Layer 3 routingIPv4 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 32 static routes and up to 16 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, LAG, VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for CIDR Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BootP)/DHCP packets SecuritySecure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication, guest VLAN, single/multiple host mode, and single/multiple sessions STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) Secure Core Technology (SCT) Ensures that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plain text or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limit the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS Supports RADIUS authentication for management access. Switch functions as a client. Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DoS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels Access Control Lists (ACLs) Support for up to 512 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, TCP/UDP source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.3 ad LACP, IEEE 802.1D (STP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 Neighbor Discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) version 6 IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, Ping, Traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP), Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS), Syslog, DNS client, DHCP client, DHCP autoconfig IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC 2463): ICMPv6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 Addressing Architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 Specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): Neighbor Discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 Stateless Address Autoconfiguration RFC 1981: Path MTU Discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 Scoped Address Architecture RFC 3484: Default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: Management Information Base (MIB) IPv6: Textual Conventions and General Group RFC 3595: Textual Conventions for IPv6 Flow Label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, wizards, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Basic and advanced mode for maximum operational efficiency SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP v3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server), to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP Relay, and host name Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfers files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with SCP file download Enables mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable configs Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Automatically applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartports roles to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments. Text view Command-Line Interface (CLI) Scriptable CLI. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI. Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP); cable diagnostics; Ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link is up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables EEE compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 8K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics using Cisco Discovery Protocol Power over Ethernet802.3at PoE+ and 802.3af PoE delivered over any of the RJ-45 ports within the listed power budgets The following switches support 802.3at PoE+, 802.3af, and Cisco prestandard (legacy) PoE. Maximum power of 30.0W to any 10/100 or Gigabit Ethernet port, until the PoE budget for the switch is reached. The total power available for PoE per switch is as follows: Power dedicated to PoE 195 W Number of ports that support PoE 48 Hardware Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=68.68W 220V=67.18W Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=276.75W 220V=270.58W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 944.31 PortsTotal system ports 52 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 4 SFP Console port Cisco Standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer 3 MB Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 445 x 350 x 44 mm (17.5 x 13.78 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 5.43 kg (11.97 lb) Power 100 to 240V 50 to 60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C: 37.3 dBA MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 1206349 Warranty Limited lifetime Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 250 Series Smart Switch Power cord Mounting kit Quick start guide (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS250-48PP-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 195W) , Tesla smart switch quatro battery (tsl-swi-scenezg4)

Cisco switch CBS250-48P-4X (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, 48xPoE+, 370W)

Cisco switch CBS250-48P-4X (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, 48xPoE+, 370W)
Detail

Cisco switch CBS250-48P-4X Řada Cisco Business 250 představuje novou generaci cenově dostupných inteligentních switchů, které kombinují vysoký síťový výkon, zabezpečení a spolehlivost s komplexní sadou síťových funkcí potřebných pro spolehlivou síť malých firem. Stránky produktu: CBS250-48P-4X Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity (All switches are wire-speed and nonblocking)Forwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 130,94 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 176 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d spanning tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple spanning tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+); 126 instances are supported Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 4 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad Link Aggregation Group (LAG) VLAN Support for up to 255 active VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers networkwide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain IGMP (versions 1, 2, and 3) snooping Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 255 multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP querier Used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router HOL blocking Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking prevention Loopback detection Provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Layer 3 routingIPv4 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 32 static routes and up to 16 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, LAG, VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for CIDR Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BootP)/DHCP packets SecuritySecure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication, guest VLAN, single/multiple host mode, and single/multiple sessions STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) Secure Core Technology (SCT) Ensures that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plain text or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limit the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS Supports RADIUS authentication for management access. Switch functions as a client. Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DoS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels Access Control Lists (ACLs) Support for up to 512 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, TCP/UDP source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.3 ad LACP, IEEE 802.1D (STP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 Neighbor Discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) version 6 IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, Ping, Traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP), Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS), Syslog, DNS client, DHCP client, DHCP autoconfig IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC 2463): ICMPv6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 Addressing Architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 Specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): Neighbor Discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 Stateless Address Autoconfiguration RFC 1981: Path MTU Discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 Scoped Address Architecture RFC 3484: Default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: Management Information Base (MIB) IPv6: Textual Conventions and General Group RFC 3595: Textual Conventions for IPv6 Flow Label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, wizards, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Basic and advanced mode for maximum operational efficiency SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP v3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server), to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP Relay, and host name Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfers files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with SCP file download Enables mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable configs Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Automatically applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartports roles to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments. Text view Command-Line Interface (CLI) Scriptable CLI. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI. Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP); cable diagnostics; Ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link is up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables EEE compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 8K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics using Cisco Discovery Protocol Power over Ethernet802.3at PoE+ and 802.3af PoE delivered over any of the RJ-45 ports within the listed power budgets The following switches support 802.3at PoE+, 802.3af, and Cisco prestandard (legacy) PoE. Maximum power of 30.0W to any 10/100 or Gigabit Ethernet port, until the PoE budget for the switch is reached. The total power available for PoE per switch is as follows: Power dedicated to PoE 370 W Number of ports that support PoE 48 Hardware Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=61.53W 220V=60.73W Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=471.975W 220V=463.32W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 1610.19 PortsTotal system ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet + 4 10 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 4 SFP+ Console port Cisco Standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer 3 MB Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e SFP-H10GB-CU1M Copper coax SFP-H10GB-CU3M Copper coax SFP-H10GB-CU5M Copper coax SFP-10G-SR Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR Single-mode fiber SFP-10G-SR-S Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR-S Single-mode fiber EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 445 x 350 x 44 mm (17.5 x 13.78 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 5.43 kg (11.97 lb) Power 100 to 240V 50 to 60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C: 37.3 dBA MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 856329 Warranty Limited lifetime Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 250 Series Smart Switch Power cord Mounting kit Quick start guide (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS250-48P-4X (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, 48xPoE+, 370W) , Netgear gs108ge (gs108ge)

Cisco switch CBS350-48T-4G-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP) - REFRESH

Cisco switch CBS350-48T-4G-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP) - REFRESH
Detail

Cisco switch CBS350-48T-4G-EU - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu Řízené switche řady Cisco Business 350 jsou spolehlivými stavebními prvky pro sítě malých firem. Díky intuitivnímu ovládacímu panelu, pokročilým funkcím a všudypřítomnému zabezpečení urychlují spravované switche řady Cisco Business 350 vaši digitální transformaci. Záruka platná do End of Support 31. 10. 2029. Oznámení End of Life pro CISCO CBS350 Stránky produktu: CBS350-48T-4G-EU Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity and forwarding rate (All switches are wire speed and nonblocking)Capacity in Millions of Packets per Second (mpps) (64-byte packets) 77,38 Switching Capacity in Gigabits per Second (Gbps) 104 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+) and Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation VLAN Support for up to 4,094 VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs; MAC-based VLAN; protocol-based VLAN; IP subnet-based VLAN Management VLAN Private VLAN with promiscuous, isolated, and community port Private VLAN Edge (PVE), also known as protected ports, with multiple uplinks Guest VLAN, unauthenticated VLAN Dynamic VLAN assignment via RADIUS server along with 802.1x client authentication CPE VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers network wide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Multicast TV VLAN Multicast TV VLAN allows the single multicast VLAN to be shared in the network while subscribers remain in separate VLANs. This feature is also known as Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR) VLAN Translation Support for VLAN One-to-One Mapping. In VLAN One-to-One Mapping, on an edge interface customer VLANs (C-VLANs) are mapped to service provider VLANs (S-VLANs) and the original C-VLAN tags are replaced by the specified S-VLAN Q-in-Q VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Selective Q-in-Q Selective Q-in-Q is an enhancement to the basic Q-in-Q feature and provides, per edge interface, multiple mappings of different C-VLANs to separate S-VLANs Selective Q-in-Q also allows configuring of Ethertype (Tag Protocol Identifier [TPID]) of the S-VLAN tag Layer 2 protocol tunneling over Q-in-Q is also supported Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP)/Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) enable automatic propagation and configuration of VLANs in a bridged domain Unidirectional Link Detection (UDLD) UDLD monitors physical connection to detect unidirectional links caused by incorrect wiring or cable/port faults to prevent forwarding loops and black holing of traffic in switched networks Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) Relay at Layer 2 Relay of DHCP traffic to DHCP server in different VLAN; works with DHCP Option 82 Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) versions 1, 2, and 3 snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 2K multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP Querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router IGMP proxy The IGMP proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on IGMP membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Loopback Detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP Layer 3IPv4 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 990 static routes and up to 128 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 Interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, Link Aggregation (LAG), VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for classless interdomain routing RIP v2 Support for Routing Information Protocol version 2 for dynamic routing Policy-Based Routing (PBR) Flexible routing control to direct packets to different next hop based on IPv4 or IPv6 Access Control List (ACL) DHCP Server Switch functions as an IPv4 DHCP server serving IP addresses for multiple DHCP pools/scopes Support for DHCP options DHCP relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP)/DHCP packets Securityecure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy Protocol (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch IEEE 802.1X (Authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication and accounting, MD5 hash; guest VLAN; unauthenticated VLAN, single/multiple host mode and single/multiple sessions Supports time-based 802.1X; dynamic VLAN assignment; MAC authentication IEEE 802.1X supplicant A switch can be configured to act as a supplicant to another switch. This enables extended secure access in areas outside the wiring closet (such as conference rooms) Web-based authentication Web-based authentication provides network admission control through web browser to any host devices and operating systems STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard A security mechanism to protect the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. This avoids accidental topology loops STP Root Guard This prevents edge devices not in the network administrator’s control from becoming Spanning Tree Protocol root nodes STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) DHCP snooping Filters out DHCP messages with unregistered IP addresses and/or from unexpected or untrusted interfaces. This prevents rogue devices from behaving as DHCP Servers. IP Source Guard (IPSG) When IP Source Guard is enabled at a port, the switch filters out IP packets received from the port if the source IP addresses of the packets have not been statically configured or dynamically learned from DHCP snooping. This prevents IP address spoofing. Dynamic ARP Inspection (DAI) The switch discards ARP packets from a port if there are no static or dynamic IP/MAC bindings or if there is a discrepancy between the source or destination addresses in the ARP packet. This prevents man-in-the-middle attacks. IP/MAC/Port Binding (IPMB) The preceding features (DHCP Snooping, IP Source Guard, and Dynamic ARP Inspection) work together to prevent DOS attacks in the network, thereby increasing network availability Secure Core Technology (SCT) Makes sure that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plaintext or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user. Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Private VLAN Private VLAN provides security and isolation between switch ports, which helps ensure that users cannot snoop on other users’ traffic; supports multiple uplinks Layer 2 isolation Private VLAN Edge (PVE) PVE (also known as protected ports) provides Layer 2 isolation between devices in the same VLAN, supports multiple uplinks Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limits the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS/TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and TACACS authentication. Switch functions as a client RADIUS accounting The RADIUS accounting functions allow data to be sent at the start and end of services, indicating the amount of resources (such as time, packets, bytes, and so on) used during the session Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DOS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels ACLs Support for up to 1,024 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID, IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol/User Datagram Protocol (TCP/UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported Quality of ServicePriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and remarking ACLs, trusted QoS Queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based; 2R3C policing Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to minimize and prevent global TCP loss synchronization iSCSI traffic optimization A mechanism for giving priority to iSCSI traffic over other types of traffic Standards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ae 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over fiber for LAN, IEEE 802.3an 10GBase-T 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over copper twisted pair cable, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w Rapid STP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, IEEE 802.1AB Link Layer Discovery Protocol, IEEE 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 826, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3176, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode; IPv6 over Ethernet; Dual IPv6/IPv4 stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND); IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration; Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD); ICMP version 6 DHCPv6 stateful client IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) tunnel support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 First Hop Security RA guard ND inspection DHCPv6 guard Neighbor binding table (snooping and static entries) Neighbor binding integrity check Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers MLD proxy The MLD proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on MLD membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, ping, traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), SNMP, RADIUS, syslog, Domain Name System (DNS) client, Telnet Client, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, IPv6 DHCP Relay, Terminal Access Controller Access Control System Plus (TACACS+) IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463): ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration RFC 1981: path MTU discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484: default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: MIB IPv6: textual conventions and general group RFC 3595: textual conventions for IPv6 flow label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports simple and advanced mode, configuration, wizards, customizable dashboard, system maintenance, monitoring, online help, and universal search SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port. Flow-based redirection and mirroring Redirect or mirror traffic to a destination port or mirroring session based on flow Remote Switch Port Analyzer (RSPAN) Traffic can be mirrored across Layer 2 domain to a remote port on a different switch for easier troubleshooting sFlow agent Switch can export sFlow sample to external collectors. sFlow provides visibility into network traffic down to flow level DHCP (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 82, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfer files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with Secure Copy (SCP) file download Enables secure mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartport roles and applies it automatically to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments Textview CLI Scriptable command-line interface. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; SSH; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; BOOTP; SNTP; Xmodem upgrade; cable diagnostics; ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables. EEE Compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 16K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics via Cisco Discovery Protocol Hardware Power Consumption (worst case)System power consumption 110V=48.27W 220V=48.64 Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 165,96 PortsTotal system ports 52 x Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 48 x Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 4 x SFP Console port Cisco standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer (All numbers are aggregate across all ports as the buffers are dynamically shared:) 3 MB Supported SFP modulesSKU Media MGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP cat 5e GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 445 x 288 x 44 mm (17.5 x 11.33 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 3.95 kg (8.71 lb) Power 100-240V 50-60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C) Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C: 29.7 dBA MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 1452667 Warranty Limited lifetime with next business day advance replacement Package contents Cisco Business 350 Series Managed Switch Power cord Mounting Kit Quick Start Guide Minimum Requirements Web browser: Chrome, Firefox, Edge, Safari Category 5e Ethernet network cable TCP/IP, network adapter, and network operating system (such as Microsoft Windows, Linux, or Mac OS X) installed (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS350-48T-4G-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP) - REFRESH , Wenko static-loc - háček, lesklý (z21794100)

Cisco switch CBS220-48P-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 382W) - REFRESH

Cisco switch CBS220-48P-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 382W) - REFRESH
Detail

Cisco switch CBS220-48P-4G - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu Řada Cisco Business 220 jsou jednoduché a cenově dostupné chytré switche pro sítě podnikové třídy. Díky podpoře mobilních aplikací, nástroji Cisco Business Dashboard a několika možnostem PoE+ poskytuje CBS220 robustní síť v rámci omezeného rozpočtu. Stránky produktu: CBS220-48P-4G Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacityForwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 74,38 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 104 Layer 2 switchingMAC table Up to 8,192 Media Access Control (MAC) addresses Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support, enabled by default Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]) Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP) 16 instances are supported Port grouping Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation Load balance based on source and destination MAC address, or source and destination MAC/IP VLAN Support for up to 256 Virtual Local Area Networks (VLANs) simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Auto voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS QinQ VLAN VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Jumbo frame Frame sizes up to 9,216 supported Loopback detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Automatic Media-Dependent Interface Crossover (MDIX) Automatically adjusts transmit and receive pairs if an incorrect cable type (crossover or straight-through) is installed. SecurityACLs Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IP address, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol (TCP)/ User Datagram Protocol (UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) packets, TCP flag Support up to 512 rules Port security Creates the ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports; limits the number of learned MAC addresses IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-in User Service (RADIUS) authentication; guest VLAN; Single-host, multiple-host, and multisession mode RADIUS, TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and Terminal Access Controller Access Control System (TACACS) authentication; switch functions as a client MAC address filtering Supported Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS protection DOS attack prevention STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard This security mechanism protects the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. Spanning Tree Loop Guard This feature provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops). Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. SCP also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues per port Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port-based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence, Type of Service (ToS), and DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow-based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization. MulticastInternet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) Versions 1, 2, and 3 Snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 256 multicast groups IGMP querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad LACP, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, Request for Comments (RFC) 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 922, RFC 920, RFC 950, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1350, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1624, RFC 1700, RFC 1867, RFC 2030, RFC 2616, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 2576, RFC 4330, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1573, RFC 1643, RFC 1757, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2233, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 1157, RFC 1493, RFC 1215, RFC 3416 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) ICMP version 6 IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) Snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, Cisco Discovery Protocol (CDP), Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) IPv6 Requests for Comments (RFCs) supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463) - ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513) - IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291 - IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460 - IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461) - Neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462) - IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration RFC 1981 - Path MTU discovery RFC 4007 - IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484 - Default address selection mechanism ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support direct management with Cisco Business Dashboard and mobile app. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a zero touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Command-line interface Scriptable CLI; a full CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1 and 15 are supported for the CLI SNMP Simple Management Network Protocol (SNMP) versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Standard Management Information Bases (MIBs) MIB-II (RFC1213) IF-MIB (RFC2863) Bridge-MIB (RFC4188) Bridge-MIB-Extension (RFC2674) RMON (RFC2819) Etherlike MIB (RFC3635) Radius Client MIB (RFC2618) Entity MIB (RFC2737) POWER-ETHERNET-MIB (RFC3621) Syslog MIB (RFC3164) Generic Traps MIB (RFC1215) SNMP-COMMUNITY-MIB SNMP-MIB LLDP-MIB LLDP-EXT-MED-MIB IEEE8023-LAG-MIB CISCO-PORT-SECURITY-MIB CISCO-ENVMON-MIB CISCO-CDP-MIB CISCO-CONFIG-COPY-MIB Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED Extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones. Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. Displays brief information for connected Cisco network devices, IP phones, and wireless access points Power efficiencyEEE compliance (802.3az) Support 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet on all ports; substantially reduce the power consumption when link bandwidth is not at full utilization Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on Gigabit Ethernet and 10/100 RJ-45 ports when detecting a link down Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy. Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy. Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up). Power over Ethernet 802.3af PoE or 802.3at PoE+ delivered over any of the RJ-45 network ports within the listed power budgets PoE Power Budget 382 W Number of Ports That Support PoE 48 Pre-standard PoE Support Cisco Pre-Standard PoE Intelligent PoE power management Support the granular power negotiation with CDP/LLDP communication with PD devices after IEEE classification HardwareButtons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5 or better for 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX; UTP Category 5 Ethernet or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, Speed Flash 64 MB CPU memory 256 MB PortsTotal system ports 52 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet Uplink ports 4 Gigabit Ethernet Small form-factor pluggable (SFP) Packet BufferPacket buffer 12 Mb Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 440 x 257 x 44 mm (17.3 x 10.1 x 1.7 in) Unit weight 5.29 kg (11.66 lb) Power 100-240 V, 50-60 Hz, Internal Certifications UL (UL 60950), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A, C-tick Operating temperature 0-50° C Storage temperature –20° C to +70° C Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=52.6W 220V=53.0W Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=478.2W 220V=464.0W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 1631.69 Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C: 34.8 dB MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 452351 Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 220 Series Ethernet switch Power cord or adaptor Mounting kit Quick start guide (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS220-48P-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 382W) - REFRESH , Sonoff rfr2 - wifi diy smart rf control switch (rfr2)

Cisco switch CBS350-48P-4G-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 370W)

Cisco switch CBS350-48P-4G-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 370W)
Detail

Cisco switch CBS350-48P-4G EAN produktu: 889728295246 Nezbytný prvek pro malé podniky Cisco CBS350-48P-4G je zásadním prvkem sítě. Je součástí široké nabídky společnosti Cisco a je optimalizován pro malé firmy. Podpora digitální transformace Switch nabízí intuitivní ovládání a pokročilé funkce, které zabezpečují vaši síť a urychlují digitální transformaci. Výhody Cisco Business 350 Series Automatizace nasazení a správa switchů. Chrání soukromí vašich zákazníků. Gigabitový Ethernet a 10GE uplink. Možnost spojení až 4 switchů do jednoho zařízení. Technické specifikace Počet portů: 52 Provedení: Rack-mount Porty: 48x GbE, 4x SFP, PoE+ Výkon: Switching capacity: 104.0 Gbps, Forwarding performance (64-byte packet size): 77.38 Mpps VLAN: Ano Protokol pro vzdálenou správu: SNMP, RMON, HTTP, HTTPS, TFTP, Telnet, SSH Standardy: IEEE 802.3, IEEE 802.3u, IEEE 802.3ab, IEEE 802.3ad, IEEE 802.3z, IEEE 802.3ae, IEEE 802.3an, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w Rapid STP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, IEEE 802.1AB Link Layer Discovery Protocol, IEEE 802.3az Velikost MAC tabulky: 16 000 RAM: 512 MB Flash: 256 MB Napájení: 100-240 V (50-60 Hz), interní Rozměry (Š x V x H): 445 x 350 x 44 mm Hmotnost: 5.43 kg Provozní teplota: -5 až 50°C Provozní vlhost: 10 - 90% Skladovací teplota: -25 až 70 °C (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS350-48P-4G-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 370W) , Moes hidden wifi smart dimmer switch 2gang (ms-105b)

Cisco switch CBS350-48P-4X-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, 48xPoE+, 370W)

Detail

Cisco switch CBS350-48P-4X-EU Řízené switche řady Cisco Business 350 jsou spolehlivými stavebními prvky pro sítě malých firem. Díky intuitivnímu ovládacímu panelu, pokročilým funkcím a všudypřítomnému zabezpečení urychlují spravované switche řady Cisco Business 350 vaši digitální transformaci. Záruka platná do End of Support 31. 10. 2029. Oznámení End of Life pro CISCO CBS350 Stránky produktu: CBS350-48P-4X-EU Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity and forwarding rate (All switches are wire speed and nonblocking)Capacity in Millions of Packets per Second (mpps) (64-byte packets) 130,94 Switching Capacity in Gigabits per Second (Gbps) 176 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+) and Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation VLAN Support for up to 4,094 VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs; MAC-based VLAN; protocol-based VLAN; IP subnet-based VLAN Management VLAN Private VLAN with promiscuous, isolated, and community port Private VLAN Edge (PVE), also known as protected ports, with multiple uplinks Guest VLAN, unauthenticated VLAN Dynamic VLAN assignment via RADIUS server along with 802.1x client authentication CPE VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers network wide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Multicast TV VLAN Multicast TV VLAN allows the single multicast VLAN to be shared in the network while subscribers remain in separate VLANs. This feature is also known as Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR) VLAN Translation Support for VLAN One-to-One Mapping. In VLAN One-to-One Mapping, on an edge interface customer VLANs (C-VLANs) are mapped to service provider VLANs (S-VLANs) and the original C-VLAN tags are replaced by the specified S-VLAN Q-in-Q VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Selective Q-in-Q Selective Q-in-Q is an enhancement to the basic Q-in-Q feature and provides, per edge interface, multiple mappings of different C-VLANs to separate S-VLANs Selective Q-in-Q also allows configuring of Ethertype (Tag Protocol Identifier [TPID]) of the S-VLAN tag Layer 2 protocol tunneling over Q-in-Q is also supported Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP)/Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) enable automatic propagation and configuration of VLANs in a bridged domain Unidirectional Link Detection (UDLD) UDLD monitors physical connection to detect unidirectional links caused by incorrect wiring or cable/port faults to prevent forwarding loops and black holing of traffic in switched networks Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) Relay at Layer 2 Relay of DHCP traffic to DHCP server in different VLAN; works with DHCP Option 82 Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) versions 1, 2, and 3 snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 2K multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP Querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router IGMP proxy The IGMP proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on IGMP membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Loopback Detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP Layer 3IPv4 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 990 static routes and up to 128 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 Interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, Link Aggregation (LAG), VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for classless interdomain routing RIP v2 Support for Routing Information Protocol version 2 for dynamic routing Policy-Based Routing (PBR) Flexible routing control to direct packets to different next hop based on IPv4 or IPv6 Access Control List (ACL) DHCP Server Switch functions as an IPv4 DHCP server serving IP addresses for multiple DHCP pools/scopes Support for DHCP options DHCP relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP)/DHCP packets StackingHardware stacking Up to 4 units in a stack. Up to 200 ports managed as a single system with hardware failover High availability Fast stack failover delivers minimal traffic loss. Support link aggregation across multiple units in a stack Plug-and-play stacking configuration/management Active/standby for resilient stack control Autonumbering Hot swap of units in stack Ring and chain stacking options, auto stacking port speed, flexible stacking port options High-speed stack interconnects Cost-effective high-speed 10G fiber interfaces. Securityecure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy Protocol (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch IEEE 802.1X (Authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication and accounting, MD5 hash; guest VLAN; unauthenticated VLAN, single/multiple host mode and single/multiple sessions Supports time-based 802.1X; dynamic VLAN assignment; MAC authentication IEEE 802.1X supplicant A switch can be configured to act as a supplicant to another switch. This enables extended secure access in areas outside the wiring closet (such as conference rooms) Web-based authentication Web-based authentication provides network admission control through web browser to any host devices and operating systems STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard A security mechanism to protect the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. This avoids accidental topology loops STP Root Guard This prevents edge devices not in the network administrator’s control from becoming Spanning Tree Protocol root nodes STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) DHCP snooping Filters out DHCP messages with unregistered IP addresses and/or from unexpected or untrusted interfaces. This prevents rogue devices from behaving as DHCP Servers. IP Source Guard (IPSG) When IP Source Guard is enabled at a port, the switch filters out IP packets received from the port if the source IP addresses of the packets have not been statically configured or dynamically learned from DHCP snooping. This prevents IP address spoofing. Dynamic ARP Inspection (DAI) The switch discards ARP packets from a port if there are no static or dynamic IP/MAC bindings or if there is a discrepancy between the source or destination addresses in the ARP packet. This prevents man-in-the-middle attacks. IP/MAC/Port Binding (IPMB) The preceding features (DHCP Snooping, IP Source Guard, and Dynamic ARP Inspection) work together to prevent DOS attacks in the network, thereby increasing network availability Secure Core Technology (SCT) Makes sure that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plaintext or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user. Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Private VLAN Private VLAN provides security and isolation between switch ports, which helps ensure that users cannot snoop on other users’ traffic; supports multiple uplinks Layer 2 isolation Private VLAN Edge (PVE) PVE (also known as protected ports) provides Layer 2 isolation between devices in the same VLAN, supports multiple uplinks Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limits the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS/TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and TACACS authentication. Switch functions as a client RADIUS accounting The RADIUS accounting functions allow data to be sent at the start and end of services, indicating the amount of resources (such as time, packets, bytes, and so on) used during the session Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DOS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels ACLs Support for up to 1,024 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID, IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol/User Datagram Protocol (TCP/UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported Quality of ServicePriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and remarking ACLs, trusted QoS Queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based; 2R3C policing Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to minimize and prevent global TCP loss synchronization iSCSI traffic optimization A mechanism for giving priority to iSCSI traffic over other types of traffic Standards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ae 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over fiber for LAN, IEEE 802.3an 10GBase-T 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over copper twisted pair cable, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w Rapid STP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, IEEE 802.1AB Link Layer Discovery Protocol, IEEE 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 826, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3176, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode; IPv6 over Ethernet; Dual IPv6/IPv4 stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND); IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration; Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD); ICMP version 6 DHCPv6 stateful client IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) tunnel support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 First Hop Security RA guard ND inspection DHCPv6 guard Neighbor binding table (snooping and static entries) Neighbor binding integrity check Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers MLD proxy The MLD proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on MLD membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, ping, traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), SNMP, RADIUS, syslog, Domain Name System (DNS) client, Telnet Client, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, IPv6 DHCP Relay, Terminal Access Controller Access Control System Plus (TACACS+) IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463): ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration RFC 1981: path MTU discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484: default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: MIB IPv6: textual conventions and general group RFC 3595: textual conventions for IPv6 flow label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports simple and advanced mode, configuration, wizards, customizable dashboard, system maintenance, monitoring, online help, and universal search SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port. Flow-based redirection and mirroring Redirect or mirror traffic to a destination port or mirroring session based on flow Remote Switch Port Analyzer (RSPAN) Traffic can be mirrored across Layer 2 domain to a remote port on a different switch for easier troubleshooting sFlow agent Switch can export sFlow sample to external collectors. sFlow provides visibility into network traffic down to flow level DHCP (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 82, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfer files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with Secure Copy (SCP) file download Enables secure mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartport roles and applies it automatically to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments Textview CLI Scriptable command-line interface. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; SSH; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; BOOTP; SNTP; Xmodem upgrade; cable diagnostics; ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables. EEE Compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 16K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics via Cisco Discovery Protocol Power over Ethernet802.3af PoE, 802.3at PoE+ or 60W PoE delivered over the RJ-45 ports within the listed power budgets The following switches support 802.3at PoE+, 802.3af, and Cisco prestandard (legacy) PoE. 60W PoE is also supported on select RJ-45 network ports on select models. The total power available for PoE per switch is as follows: Power dedicated to PoE 370 W Number of Ports That Support PoE 48 Hardware Power Consumption (worst case)System power consumption 110V=61.53W 220V=60.73 Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=471.90W 220V=463.32W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 1610.19 PortsTotal system ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet + 4 x 10G RJ-45 ports 48 x Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 4 x SFP+ Console port Cisco standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer (All numbers are aggregate across all ports as the buffers are dynamically shared:) 3 MB Supported SFP modulesSKU Media MGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP cat 5e GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e SFP-H10GB-CU1M Copper coax SFP-H10GB-CU3M Copper coax SFP-H10GB-CU5M Copper coax SFP-10G-SR Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR Single-mode fiber SFP-10G-SR-S Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR-S Single-mode fiber EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 445 x 350 x 44 mm (17.5 x 13.78 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 5.43 kg (11.97 lb) Power 100-240V 50-60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C) Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C:37.3 dBA MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 856329 Warranty Limited lifetime with next business day advance replacement Package contents Cisco Business 350 Series Managed Switch Power cord Mounting Kit Quick Start Guide Minimum Requirements Web browser: Chrome, Firefox, Edge, Safari Category 5e Ethernet network cable TCP/IP, network adapter, and network operating system (such as Microsoft Windows, Linux, or Mac OS X) installed (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS350-48P-4X-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, 48xPoE+, 370W) , Moes smart wifi+rf433 switch (with neutral) (ws-eub2)

Cisco switch CBS250-48PP-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 195W) - REFRESH

Cisco switch CBS250-48PP-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 195W) - REFRESH
Detail

Cisco switch CBS250-48PP-4G - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu Řada Cisco Business 250 představuje novou generaci cenově dostupných inteligentních switchů, které kombinují vysoký síťový výkon, zabezpečení a spolehlivost s komplexní sadou síťových funkcí potřebných pro spolehlivou síť malých firem. Záruka platná do End of Support 31. 10. 2029. Oznámení End of Life pro CISCO CBS250 Stránky produktu: CBS250-48PP-4G Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity (All switches are wire-speed and nonblocking)Forwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 77,38 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 104 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d spanning tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple spanning tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+); 126 instances are supported Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 4 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad Link Aggregation Group (LAG) VLAN Support for up to 255 active VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers networkwide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain IGMP (versions 1, 2, and 3) snooping Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 255 multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP querier Used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router HOL blocking Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking prevention Loopback detection Provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Layer 3 routingIPv4 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 32 static routes and up to 16 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, LAG, VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for CIDR Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BootP)/DHCP packets SecuritySecure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication, guest VLAN, single/multiple host mode, and single/multiple sessions STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) Secure Core Technology (SCT) Ensures that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plain text or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limit the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS Supports RADIUS authentication for management access. Switch functions as a client. Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DoS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels Access Control Lists (ACLs) Support for up to 512 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, TCP/UDP source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.3 ad LACP, IEEE 802.1D (STP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 Neighbor Discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) version 6 IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, Ping, Traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP), Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS), Syslog, DNS client, DHCP client, DHCP autoconfig IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC 2463): ICMPv6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 Addressing Architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 Specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): Neighbor Discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 Stateless Address Autoconfiguration RFC 1981: Path MTU Discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 Scoped Address Architecture RFC 3484: Default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: Management Information Base (MIB) IPv6: Textual Conventions and General Group RFC 3595: Textual Conventions for IPv6 Flow Label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, wizards, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Basic and advanced mode for maximum operational efficiency SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP v3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server), to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP Relay, and host name Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfers files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with SCP file download Enables mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable configs Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Automatically applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartports roles to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments. Text view Command-Line Interface (CLI) Scriptable CLI. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI. Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP); cable diagnostics; Ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link is up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables EEE compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 8K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics using Cisco Discovery Protocol Power over Ethernet802.3at PoE+ and 802.3af PoE delivered over any of the RJ-45 ports within the listed power budgets The following switches support 802.3at PoE+, 802.3af, and Cisco prestandard (legacy) PoE. Maximum power of 30.0W to any 10/100 or Gigabit Ethernet port, until the PoE budget for the switch is reached. The total power available for PoE per switch is as follows: Power dedicated to PoE 195 W Number of ports that support PoE 48 Hardware Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=68.68W 220V=67.18W Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=276.75W 220V=270.58W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 944.31 PortsTotal system ports 52 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 4 SFP Console port Cisco Standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer 3 MB Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 445 x 350 x 44 mm (17.5 x 13.78 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 5.43 kg (11.97 lb) Power 100 to 240V 50 to 60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C: 37.3 dBA MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 1206349 Warranty Limited lifetime Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 250 Series Smart Switch Power cord Mounting kit Quick start guide (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS250-48PP-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 195W) - REFRESH , Immax neo lite smart vypínač / switch 16a, wifi (07731l)

Cisco switch CBS250-48P-4X (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, 48xPoE+, 370W) - REFRESH

Cisco switch CBS250-48P-4X (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, 48xPoE+, 370W) - REFRESH
Detail

Cisco switch CBS250-48P-4X - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu Řada Cisco Business 250 představuje novou generaci cenově dostupných inteligentních switchů, které kombinují vysoký síťový výkon, zabezpečení a spolehlivost s komplexní sadou síťových funkcí potřebných pro spolehlivou síť malých firem. Záruka platná do End of Support 31. 10. 2029. Oznámení End of Life pro CISCO CBS250 Stránky produktu: CBS250-48P-4X Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity (All switches are wire-speed and nonblocking)Forwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 130,94 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 176 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d spanning tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple spanning tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+); 126 instances are supported Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 4 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad Link Aggregation Group (LAG) VLAN Support for up to 255 active VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers networkwide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain IGMP (versions 1, 2, and 3) snooping Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 255 multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP querier Used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router HOL blocking Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking prevention Loopback detection Provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Layer 3 routingIPv4 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 32 static routes and up to 16 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, LAG, VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for CIDR Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BootP)/DHCP packets SecuritySecure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication, guest VLAN, single/multiple host mode, and single/multiple sessions STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) Secure Core Technology (SCT) Ensures that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plain text or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limit the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS Supports RADIUS authentication for management access. Switch functions as a client. Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DoS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels Access Control Lists (ACLs) Support for up to 512 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, TCP/UDP source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.3 ad LACP, IEEE 802.1D (STP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 Neighbor Discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) version 6 IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, Ping, Traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP), Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS), Syslog, DNS client, DHCP client, DHCP autoconfig IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC 2463): ICMPv6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 Addressing Architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 Specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): Neighbor Discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 Stateless Address Autoconfiguration RFC 1981: Path MTU Discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 Scoped Address Architecture RFC 3484: Default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: Management Information Base (MIB) IPv6: Textual Conventions and General Group RFC 3595: Textual Conventions for IPv6 Flow Label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, wizards, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Basic and advanced mode for maximum operational efficiency SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP v3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server), to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP Relay, and host name Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfers files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with SCP file download Enables mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable configs Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Automatically applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartports roles to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments. Text view Command-Line Interface (CLI) Scriptable CLI. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI. Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP); cable diagnostics; Ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link is up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables EEE compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 8K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics using Cisco Discovery Protocol Power over Ethernet802.3at PoE+ and 802.3af PoE delivered over any of the RJ-45 ports within the listed power budgets The following switches support 802.3at PoE+, 802.3af, and Cisco prestandard (legacy) PoE. Maximum power of 30.0W to any 10/100 or Gigabit Ethernet port, until the PoE budget for the switch is reached. The total power available for PoE per switch is as follows: Power dedicated to PoE 370 W Number of ports that support PoE 48 Hardware Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=61.53W 220V=60.73W Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=471.975W 220V=463.32W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 1610.19 PortsTotal system ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet + 4 10 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 4 SFP+ Console port Cisco Standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer 3 MB Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e SFP-H10GB-CU1M Copper coax SFP-H10GB-CU3M Copper coax SFP-H10GB-CU5M Copper coax SFP-10G-SR Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR Single-mode fiber SFP-10G-SR-S Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR-S Single-mode fiber EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 445 x 350 x 44 mm (17.5 x 13.78 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 5.43 kg (11.97 lb) Power 100 to 240V 50 to 60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C: 37.3 dBA MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 856329 Warranty Limited lifetime Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 250 Series Smart Switch Power cord Mounting kit Quick start guide (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS250-48P-4X (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, 48xPoE+, 370W) - REFRESH , Moes smart wifi touch dimmer switch (edm-01aa-eu)

Cisco switch CBS350-48FP-4G-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 740W)

Detail

Cisco switch CBS350-48FP-4G-EU Řízené switche řady Cisco Business 350 jsou spolehlivými stavebními prvky pro sítě malých firem. Díky intuitivnímu ovládacímu panelu, pokročilým funkcím a všudypřítomnému zabezpečení urychlují spravované switche řady Cisco Business 350 vaši digitální transformaci. Stránky produktu: CBS350-48FP-4G-EU Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity and forwarding rate (All switches are wire speed and nonblocking)Capacity in Millions of Packets per Second (mpps) (64-byte packets) 77,38 Switching Capacity in Gigabits per Second (Gbps) 104 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+) and Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation VLAN Support for up to 4,094 VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs; MAC-based VLAN; protocol-based VLAN; IP subnet-based VLAN Management VLAN Private VLAN with promiscuous, isolated, and community port Private VLAN Edge (PVE), also known as protected ports, with multiple uplinks Guest VLAN, unauthenticated VLAN Dynamic VLAN assignment via RADIUS server along with 802.1x client authentication CPE VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers network wide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Multicast TV VLAN Multicast TV VLAN allows the single multicast VLAN to be shared in the network while subscribers remain in separate VLANs. This feature is also known as Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR) VLAN Translation Support for VLAN One-to-One Mapping. In VLAN One-to-One Mapping, on an edge interface customer VLANs (C-VLANs) are mapped to service provider VLANs (S-VLANs) and the original C-VLAN tags are replaced by the specified S-VLAN Q-in-Q VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Selective Q-in-Q Selective Q-in-Q is an enhancement to the basic Q-in-Q feature and provides, per edge interface, multiple mappings of different C-VLANs to separate S-VLANs Selective Q-in-Q also allows configuring of Ethertype (Tag Protocol Identifier [TPID]) of the S-VLAN tag Layer 2 protocol tunneling over Q-in-Q is also supported Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP)/Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) enable automatic propagation and configuration of VLANs in a bridged domain Unidirectional Link Detection (UDLD) UDLD monitors physical connection to detect unidirectional links caused by incorrect wiring or cable/port faults to prevent forwarding loops and black holing of traffic in switched networks Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) Relay at Layer 2 Relay of DHCP traffic to DHCP server in different VLAN; works with DHCP Option 82 Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) versions 1, 2, and 3 snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 2K multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP Querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router IGMP proxy The IGMP proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on IGMP membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Loopback Detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP Layer 3IPv4 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 990 static routes and up to 128 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 Interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, Link Aggregation (LAG), VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for classless interdomain routing RIP v2 Support for Routing Information Protocol version 2 for dynamic routing Policy-Based Routing (PBR) Flexible routing control to direct packets to different next hop based on IPv4 or IPv6 Access Control List (ACL) DHCP Server Switch functions as an IPv4 DHCP server serving IP addresses for multiple DHCP pools/scopes Support for DHCP options DHCP relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP)/DHCP packets Securityecure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy Protocol (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch IEEE 802.1X (Authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication and accounting, MD5 hash; guest VLAN; unauthenticated VLAN, single/multiple host mode and single/multiple sessions Supports time-based 802.1X; dynamic VLAN assignment; MAC authentication IEEE 802.1X supplicant A switch can be configured to act as a supplicant to another switch. This enables extended secure access in areas outside the wiring closet (such as conference rooms) Web-based authentication Web-based authentication provides network admission control through web browser to any host devices and operating systems STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard A security mechanism to protect the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. This avoids accidental topology loops STP Root Guard This prevents edge devices not in the network administrator’s control from becoming Spanning Tree Protocol root nodes STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) DHCP snooping Filters out DHCP messages with unregistered IP addresses and/or from unexpected or untrusted interfaces. This prevents rogue devices from behaving as DHCP Servers. IP Source Guard (IPSG) When IP Source Guard is enabled at a port, the switch filters out IP packets received from the port if the source IP addresses of the packets have not been statically configured or dynamically learned from DHCP snooping. This prevents IP address spoofing. Dynamic ARP Inspection (DAI) The switch discards ARP packets from a port if there are no static or dynamic IP/MAC bindings or if there is a discrepancy between the source or destination addresses in the ARP packet. This prevents man-in-the-middle attacks. IP/MAC/Port Binding (IPMB) The preceding features (DHCP Snooping, IP Source Guard, and Dynamic ARP Inspection) work together to prevent DOS attacks in the network, thereby increasing network availability Secure Core Technology (SCT) Makes sure that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plaintext or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user. Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Private VLAN Private VLAN provides security and isolation between switch ports, which helps ensure that users cannot snoop on other users’ traffic; supports multiple uplinks Layer 2 isolation Private VLAN Edge (PVE) PVE (also known as protected ports) provides Layer 2 isolation between devices in the same VLAN, supports multiple uplinks Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limits the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS/TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and TACACS authentication. Switch functions as a client RADIUS accounting The RADIUS accounting functions allow data to be sent at the start and end of services, indicating the amount of resources (such as time, packets, bytes, and so on) used during the session Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DOS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels ACLs Support for up to 1,024 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID, IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol/User Datagram Protocol (TCP/UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported Quality of ServicePriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and remarking ACLs, trusted QoS Queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based; 2R3C policing Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to minimize and prevent global TCP loss synchronization iSCSI traffic optimization A mechanism for giving priority to iSCSI traffic over other types of traffic Standards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ae 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over fiber for LAN, IEEE 802.3an 10GBase-T 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over copper twisted pair cable, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w Rapid STP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, IEEE 802.1AB Link Layer Discovery Protocol, IEEE 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 826, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3176, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode; IPv6 over Ethernet; Dual IPv6/IPv4 stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND); IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration; Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD); ICMP version 6 DHCPv6 stateful client IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) tunnel support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 First Hop Security RA guard ND inspection DHCPv6 guard Neighbor binding table (snooping and static entries) Neighbor binding integrity check Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers MLD proxy The MLD proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on MLD membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, ping, traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), SNMP, RADIUS, syslog, Domain Name System (DNS) client, Telnet Client, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, IPv6 DHCP Relay, Terminal Access Controller Access Control System Plus (TACACS+) IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463): ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration RFC 1981: path MTU discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484: default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: MIB IPv6: textual conventions and general group RFC 3595: textual conventions for IPv6 flow label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports simple and advanced mode, configuration, wizards, customizable dashboard, system maintenance, monitoring, online help, and universal search SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port. Flow-based redirection and mirroring Redirect or mirror traffic to a destination port or mirroring session based on flow Remote Switch Port Analyzer (RSPAN) Traffic can be mirrored across Layer 2 domain to a remote port on a different switch for easier troubleshooting sFlow agent Switch can export sFlow sample to external collectors. sFlow provides visibility into network traffic down to flow level DHCP (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 82, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfer files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with Secure Copy (SCP) file download Enables secure mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartport roles and applies it automatically to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments Textview CLI Scriptable command-line interface. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; SSH; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; BOOTP; SNTP; Xmodem upgrade; cable diagnostics; ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables. EEE Compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 16K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics via Cisco Discovery Protocol Power over Ethernet802.3af PoE, 802.3at PoE+ or 60W PoE delivered over the RJ-45 ports within the listed power budgets The following switches support 802.3at PoE+, 802.3af, and Cisco prestandard (legacy) PoE. 60W PoE is also supported on select RJ-45 network ports on select models. The total power available for PoE per switch is as follows: Power dedicated to PoE 740 W Number of Ports That Support PoE 48 Hardware Power Consumption (worst case)System power consumption 110V=60.77W 220V=59.73 Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=451.95W 220V=445.85W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 1542.12 PortsTotal system ports 52 x Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 48 x Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 4 x SFP Console port Cisco standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer (All numbers are aggregate across all ports as the buffers are dynamically shared:) 3 MB Supported SFP modulesSKU Media MGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP cat 5e GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 445 x 350 x 44 mm (17.5 x 13.78 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 5.43 kg (11.97 lb) Power 100-240V 50-60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C) Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C:37.3 dBA MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 856329 Warranty Limited lifetime with next business day advance replacement Package contents Cisco Business 350 Series Managed Switch Power cord Mounting Kit Quick Start Guide Minimum Requirements Web browser: Chrome, Firefox, Edge, Safari Category 5e Ethernet network cable TCP/IP, network adapter, and network operating system (such as Microsoft Windows, Linux, or Mac OS X) installed (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS350-48FP-4G-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 740W) , Moes smart wifi rotary dimmer switch (edm-01waa-eu)

Cisco switch CBS350-48FP-4X-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, 48xPoE+, 740W)

Cisco switch CBS350-48FP-4X-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, 48xPoE+, 740W)
Detail

Cisco switch CBS350-48FP-4X-EU Řízené switche řady Cisco Business 350 jsou spolehlivými stavebními prvky pro sítě malých firem. Díky intuitivnímu ovládacímu panelu, pokročilým funkcím a všudypřítomnému zabezpečení urychlují spravované switche řady Cisco Business 350 vaši digitální transformaci. Záruka platná do End of Support 31. 10. 2029. Oznámení End of Life pro CISCO CBS350 Stránky produktu: CBS350-48FP-4X-EU Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity and forwarding rate (All switches are wire speed and nonblocking)Capacity in Millions of Packets per Second (mpps) (64-byte packets) 130,94 Switching Capacity in Gigabits per Second (Gbps) 176 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+) and Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation VLAN Support for up to 4,094 VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs; MAC-based VLAN; protocol-based VLAN; IP subnet-based VLAN Management VLAN Private VLAN with promiscuous, isolated, and community port Private VLAN Edge (PVE), also known as protected ports, with multiple uplinks Guest VLAN, unauthenticated VLAN Dynamic VLAN assignment via RADIUS server along with 802.1x client authentication CPE VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers network wide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Multicast TV VLAN Multicast TV VLAN allows the single multicast VLAN to be shared in the network while subscribers remain in separate VLANs. This feature is also known as Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR) VLAN Translation Support for VLAN One-to-One Mapping. In VLAN One-to-One Mapping, on an edge interface customer VLANs (C-VLANs) are mapped to service provider VLANs (S-VLANs) and the original C-VLAN tags are replaced by the specified S-VLAN Q-in-Q VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Selective Q-in-Q Selective Q-in-Q is an enhancement to the basic Q-in-Q feature and provides, per edge interface, multiple mappings of different C-VLANs to separate S-VLANs Selective Q-in-Q also allows configuring of Ethertype (Tag Protocol Identifier [TPID]) of the S-VLAN tag Layer 2 protocol tunneling over Q-in-Q is also supported Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP)/Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) enable automatic propagation and configuration of VLANs in a bridged domain Unidirectional Link Detection (UDLD) UDLD monitors physical connection to detect unidirectional links caused by incorrect wiring or cable/port faults to prevent forwarding loops and black holing of traffic in switched networks Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) Relay at Layer 2 Relay of DHCP traffic to DHCP server in different VLAN; works with DHCP Option 82 Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) versions 1, 2, and 3 snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 2K multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP Querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router IGMP proxy The IGMP proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on IGMP membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Loopback Detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP Layer 3IPv4 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 990 static routes and up to 128 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 Interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, Link Aggregation (LAG), VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for classless interdomain routing RIP v2 Support for Routing Information Protocol version 2 for dynamic routing Policy-Based Routing (PBR) Flexible routing control to direct packets to different next hop based on IPv4 or IPv6 Access Control List (ACL) DHCP Server Switch functions as an IPv4 DHCP server serving IP addresses for multiple DHCP pools/scopes Support for DHCP options DHCP relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP)/DHCP packets StackingHardware stacking Up to 4 units in a stack. Up to 200 ports managed as a single system with hardware failover High availability Fast stack failover delivers minimal traffic loss. Support link aggregation across multiple units in a stack Plug-and-play stacking configuration/management Active/standby for resilient stack control Autonumbering Hot swap of units in stack Ring and chain stacking options, auto stacking port speed, flexible stacking port options High-speed stack interconnects Cost-effective high-speed 10G fiber interfaces. Securityecure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy Protocol (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch IEEE 802.1X (Authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication and accounting, MD5 hash; guest VLAN; unauthenticated VLAN, single/multiple host mode and single/multiple sessions Supports time-based 802.1X; dynamic VLAN assignment; MAC authentication IEEE 802.1X supplicant A switch can be configured to act as a supplicant to another switch. This enables extended secure access in areas outside the wiring closet (such as conference rooms) Web-based authentication Web-based authentication provides network admission control through web browser to any host devices and operating systems STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard A security mechanism to protect the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. This avoids accidental topology loops STP Root Guard This prevents edge devices not in the network administrator’s control from becoming Spanning Tree Protocol root nodes STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) DHCP snooping Filters out DHCP messages with unregistered IP addresses and/or from unexpected or untrusted interfaces. This prevents rogue devices from behaving as DHCP Servers. IP Source Guard (IPSG) When IP Source Guard is enabled at a port, the switch filters out IP packets received from the port if the source IP addresses of the packets have not been statically configured or dynamically learned from DHCP snooping. This prevents IP address spoofing. Dynamic ARP Inspection (DAI) The switch discards ARP packets from a port if there are no static or dynamic IP/MAC bindings or if there is a discrepancy between the source or destination addresses in the ARP packet. This prevents man-in-the-middle attacks. IP/MAC/Port Binding (IPMB) The preceding features (DHCP Snooping, IP Source Guard, and Dynamic ARP Inspection) work together to prevent DOS attacks in the network, thereby increasing network availability Secure Core Technology (SCT) Makes sure that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plaintext or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user. Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Private VLAN Private VLAN provides security and isolation between switch ports, which helps ensure that users cannot snoop on other users’ traffic; supports multiple uplinks Layer 2 isolation Private VLAN Edge (PVE) PVE (also known as protected ports) provides Layer 2 isolation between devices in the same VLAN, supports multiple uplinks Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limits the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS/TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and TACACS authentication. Switch functions as a client RADIUS accounting The RADIUS accounting functions allow data to be sent at the start and end of services, indicating the amount of resources (such as time, packets, bytes, and so on) used during the session Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DOS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels ACLs Support for up to 1,024 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID, IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol/User Datagram Protocol (TCP/UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported Quality of ServicePriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and remarking ACLs, trusted QoS Queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based; 2R3C policing Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to minimize and prevent global TCP loss synchronization iSCSI traffic optimization A mechanism for giving priority to iSCSI traffic over other types of traffic Standards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ae 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over fiber for LAN, IEEE 802.3an 10GBase-T 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over copper twisted pair cable, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w Rapid STP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, IEEE 802.1AB Link Layer Discovery Protocol, IEEE 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 826, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3176, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode; IPv6 over Ethernet; Dual IPv6/IPv4 stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND); IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration; Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD); ICMP version 6 DHCPv6 stateful client IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) tunnel support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 First Hop Security RA guard ND inspection DHCPv6 guard Neighbor binding table (snooping and static entries) Neighbor binding integrity check Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers MLD proxy The MLD proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on MLD membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, ping, traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), SNMP, RADIUS, syslog, Domain Name System (DNS) client, Telnet Client, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, IPv6 DHCP Relay, Terminal Access Controller Access Control System Plus (TACACS+) IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463): ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration RFC 1981: path MTU discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484: default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: MIB IPv6: textual conventions and general group RFC 3595: textual conventions for IPv6 flow label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports simple and advanced mode, configuration, wizards, customizable dashboard, system maintenance, monitoring, online help, and universal search SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port. Flow-based redirection and mirroring Redirect or mirror traffic to a destination port or mirroring session based on flow Remote Switch Port Analyzer (RSPAN) Traffic can be mirrored across Layer 2 domain to a remote port on a different switch for easier troubleshooting sFlow agent Switch can export sFlow sample to external collectors. sFlow provides visibility into network traffic down to flow level DHCP (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 82, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfer files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with Secure Copy (SCP) file download Enables secure mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartport roles and applies it automatically to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments Textview CLI Scriptable command-line interface. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; SSH; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; BOOTP; SNTP; Xmodem upgrade; cable diagnostics; ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables. EEE Compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 16K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics via Cisco Discovery Protocol Power over Ethernet802.3af PoE, 802.3at PoE+ or 60W PoE delivered over the RJ-45 ports within the listed power budgets The following switches support 802.3at PoE+, 802.3af, and Cisco prestandard (legacy) PoE. 60W PoE is also supported on select RJ-45 network ports on select models. The total power available for PoE per switch is as follows: Power dedicated to PoE 740 W Number of Ports That Support PoE 48 Hardware Power Consumption (worst case)System power consumption 110V=76.18W 220V=76.22 Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=889.35W 220V=865.02W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 3034.59 PortsTotal system ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet + 4 x 10G RJ-45 ports 48 x Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 4 x SFP+ Console port Cisco standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer (All numbers are aggregate across all ports as the buffers are dynamically shared:) 3 MB Supported SFP modulesSKU Media MGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP cat 5e GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e SFP-H10GB-CU1M Copper coax SFP-H10GB-CU3M Copper coax SFP-H10GB-CU5M Copper coax SFP-10G-SR Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR Single-mode fiber SFP-10G-SR-S Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR-S Single-mode fiber EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 445 x 350 x 44 mm (17.5 x 13.78 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 5.82 kg (12.83 lb) Power 100-240V 50-60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C) Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C:48.7 dBA MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 856301 Warranty Limited lifetime with next business day advance replacement Package contents Cisco Business 350 Series Managed Switch Power cord Mounting Kit Quick Start Guide Minimum Requirements Web browser: Chrome, Firefox, Edge, Safari Category 5e Ethernet network cable TCP/IP, network adapter, and network operating system (such as Microsoft Windows, Linux, or Mac OS X) installed (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS350-48FP-4X-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, 48xPoE+, 740W) , Moes hidden wifi smart switch 2 gang (ms-104b)

TP-Link OMADA JetStream switch TL-SG3452 (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 2xConsole, fanless)

TP-Link OMADA JetStream switch TL-SG3452 (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 2xConsole, fanless)
Detail

TP-Link JetStream Switch TL-SG3452 Produktové číslo: 6935364010751 Výhody a hlavní funkce 48 gigabitových portů RJ45 a 4 porty SFP Integrace do platformy Omada SDN Centralizovaná cloudová správa Statické směrování pro efektivní využití sítě Robustní zabezpečení včetně vázání na IP-MAC Optimalizovaný přenos hlasu a videa Webové rozhraní pro samostatnou správu Technické specifikace Hardware Porty: 48× 10/100/1000 Mbps RJ45, 4× Gigabit SFP Slots, 1× RJ45 Console Port, 1× Micro-USB Console Port Ventilátor: Bez ventilátoru Napájení: 100-240 V AC 50/60 Hz Rozměry: 17.3×8.7×1.7 in (440×220×44 mm) Montáž: Rack Mountable Spotřeba: 32.8 W (220 V/ 50 Hz) Dissipace tepla: 111.91 BTU/h (220 V / 50 Hz) Výkon Přepínací kapacita: 104 Gbps Rychlost předávání paketů: 77.4 Mpps MAC adresa: 16 K Buffer paměť: 12 Mbit Jumbo Frame: 9 KB Software Kvalita služby 8 prioritních front 802.1p CoS/DSCP priorita Queue scheduling Bandwidth Control Smoother Performance Action for Flows L2 a L2+ funkce Link Aggregation Spanning Tree Protocol Loopback Detection Flow Control Mirroring L2 Multicast Podpora 511 (IPv4, IPv6) IGMP skupin IGMP Snooping IGMP ověřování MVR MLD Snooping VLAN VLAN skupina 802.1q Tagged VLAN MAC VLAN: 12 Entries Protokol VLAN GVRP VLAN VPN (QinQ) Voice VLAN Access Control List Time-based ACL MAC ACL IP ACL Combined ACL Packet Content ACL IPv6 ACL Policy Zabezpečení IP-MAC-Port Binding IPv6-MAC-Port Binding DoS Defend Static/Dynamic Port Security Broadcast/Multicast/Unicast Storm Control IP/Port/MAC based access control 802.1X IPv6 IPv6 Dual IPv4/IPv6 Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD) Snooping IPv6 ACL IPv6 Interface Static IPv6 Routing IPv6 neighbor discovery (ND) Path maximum transmission unit (MTU) discovery Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) version 6 TCPv6/UDPv6 IPv6 aplikace L3 funkce 16 IPv4/IPv6 rozhraní Statické směrování Statické ARP 316 ARP Entries Proxy ARP Gratuitous ARP DHCP Server DHCP Relay DHCP L2 Relay Správa Webové GUI Command Line Interface (CLI) přes konzolový port, telnet SNMPv1/v2c/v3 SDM šablona DHCP/BOOTP klient 802.1ab LLDP/LLDP-MED DHCP AutoInstall Dual Image, Dual Configuration CPU Monitoring Diagnostika kabelu EEE Obnovení hesla SNTP System Log Certifikace a systémové požadavky Certifikace: CE, FCC, RoHS Systémové požadavky: Microsoft Windows 98SE, NT, 2000, XP, Vista™ nebo Windows 7/8/10/11, MAC OS, NetWare, UNIX nebo Linux. Provozní teplota: 0–40 °C Skladovací teplota: -40–70 °C Provozní vlhkost: 10–90% RH bez kondenzace Skladovací vlhkost: 5–90% RH bez kondenzace (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako TP-Link OMADA JetStream switch TL-SG3452 (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 2xConsole, fanless) , Moes smart bluetooth+ wifi+rf433 switch (ws-eu2-rfw-n)

TP-Link OMADA JetStream switch TL-SG3452X (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, 2xconsole, fanless)

Detail

TP-Link JetStream switch TL-SG3452X EAN: 6935364006471 Obecný popis TP-Link JetStream switch TL-SG3452X je řízený switch L2+ s 48 gigabitovými porty a 4 10GE SFP+ sloty. Výhody produktu 4 sloty SFP+ s rychlostí 10 Gbit/s pro bleskurychlé odchozí připojení 10G. 48 gigabitových portů RJ45 pro vysokorychlostní a spolehlivé spojení. Integrováno do platformy Omada SDN pro snadnou správu a monitorování. Statické směrování pro efektivní využívání síťových prostředků. Robustní strategie zabezpečení včetně IP-MAC vázání, ACL, zabezpečení portů a další. Optimalizovaný přenos hlasu a videa v aplikacích díky L2/L3/L4 QoS a funkci IGMP Snooping. Technické specifikace Interface: 48× 10/100/1000 Mbps RJ45 Ports, 4× 10G SFP+ Slots, 1× RJ45 Console Port, 1× Micro-USB Console Port Power Supply: 100-240 V AC 50/60 Hz Dimensions: 17.3 × 8.7 × 1.7 in (440 × 220 × 44 mm) Mounting: Rack Mountable Max Power Consumption: 32.72 W (110V/60Hz) Max Heat Dissipation: 111.65 BTU/h (110 V/60 Hz) Switching Capacity: 176 Gbps Packet Forwarding Rate: 130.9 Mpps MAC Address Table: 16 K Packet Buffer Memory: 12 Mbit Jumbo Frame: 9 KB Software Features Quality of Service, L2 and L2+ Features, L2 Multicast, VLAN, Access Control List, Security, IPv6, L3 Features, Advanced Features, MIBs Management Omada App, Centralized Management, Cloud Access, Zero-Touch Provisioning, Management Features Certification CE, FCC, RoHS Package Contents TL-SG3452X Switch, Power Cord, Quick Installation Guide, Rackmount Kit, Rubber Feet System Requirements Microsoft Windows 98SE, NT, 2000, XP, Vista™ or Windows 7/8/10/11, MAC OS, NetWare, UNIX or Linux. Environment Operating Temperature: 0–45 °C (32–113 °F); Storage Temperature: -40–70 °C (-40–158 °F); Operating Humidity: 10–90% RH non-condensing; Storage Humidity: 5–90% RH non-condensing (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako TP-Link OMADA JetStream switch TL-SG3452X (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, 2xconsole, fanless) , Moes smart bluetooth+ wifi+rf433 switch (ws-eu3-rfw-n)

Cisco switch CBS350-48FP-4G-UK (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 740W) - REFRESH

Cisco switch CBS350-48FP-4G-UK (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 740W) - REFRESH
Detail

Cisco switch CBS350-48FP-4G-UK - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu UK = produkt určený pro trh v Anglii identický produkt k EU modelům s rozdílem napájecího kabelu pro UK, náhradní kabel CAB-TA-EU je součástí objednávky Řízené switche řady Cisco Business 350 jsou spolehlivými stavebními prvky pro sítě malých firem. Díky intuitivnímu ovládacímu panelu, pokročilým funkcím a všudypřítomnému zabezpečení urychlují spravované switche řady Cisco Business 350 vaši digitální transformaci. Záruka platná do End of Support 31. 10. 2029. Oznámení End of Life pro CISCO CBS350 Stránky produktu: CBS350-48FP-4G-EU Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity and forwarding rate (All switches are wire speed and nonblocking)Capacity in Millions of Packets per Second (mpps) (64-byte packets) 77,38 Switching Capacity in Gigabits per Second (Gbps) 104 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+) and Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation VLAN Support for up to 4,094 VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs; MAC-based VLAN; protocol-based VLAN; IP subnet-based VLAN Management VLAN Private VLAN with promiscuous, isolated, and community port Private VLAN Edge (PVE), also known as protected ports, with multiple uplinks Guest VLAN, unauthenticated VLAN Dynamic VLAN assignment via RADIUS server along with 802.1x client authentication CPE VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers network wide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Multicast TV VLAN Multicast TV VLAN allows the single multicast VLAN to be shared in the network while subscribers remain in separate VLANs. This feature is also known as Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR) VLAN Translation Support for VLAN One-to-One Mapping. In VLAN One-to-One Mapping, on an edge interface customer VLANs (C-VLANs) are mapped to service provider VLANs (S-VLANs) and the original C-VLAN tags are replaced by the specified S-VLAN Q-in-Q VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Selective Q-in-Q Selective Q-in-Q is an enhancement to the basic Q-in-Q feature and provides, per edge interface, multiple mappings of different C-VLANs to separate S-VLANs Selective Q-in-Q also allows configuring of Ethertype (Tag Protocol Identifier [TPID]) of the S-VLAN tag Layer 2 protocol tunneling over Q-in-Q is also supported Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP)/Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) enable automatic propagation and configuration of VLANs in a bridged domain Unidirectional Link Detection (UDLD) UDLD monitors physical connection to detect unidirectional links caused by incorrect wiring or cable/port faults to prevent forwarding loops and black holing of traffic in switched networks Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) Relay at Layer 2 Relay of DHCP traffic to DHCP server in different VLAN; works with DHCP Option 82 Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) versions 1, 2, and 3 snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 2K multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP Querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router IGMP proxy The IGMP proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on IGMP membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Loopback Detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP Layer 3IPv4 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 990 static routes and up to 128 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 Interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, Link Aggregation (LAG), VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for classless interdomain routing RIP v2 Support for Routing Information Protocol version 2 for dynamic routing Policy-Based Routing (PBR) Flexible routing control to direct packets to different next hop based on IPv4 or IPv6 Access Control List (ACL) DHCP Server Switch functions as an IPv4 DHCP server serving IP addresses for multiple DHCP pools/scopes Support for DHCP options DHCP relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP)/DHCP packets Securityecure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy Protocol (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch IEEE 802.1X (Authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication and accounting, MD5 hash; guest VLAN; unauthenticated VLAN, single/multiple host mode and single/multiple sessions Supports time-based 802.1X; dynamic VLAN assignment; MAC authentication IEEE 802.1X supplicant A switch can be configured to act as a supplicant to another switch. This enables extended secure access in areas outside the wiring closet (such as conference rooms) Web-based authentication Web-based authentication provides network admission control through web browser to any host devices and operating systems STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard A security mechanism to protect the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. This avoids accidental topology loops STP Root Guard This prevents edge devices not in the network administrator’s control from becoming Spanning Tree Protocol root nodes STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) DHCP snooping Filters out DHCP messages with unregistered IP addresses and/or from unexpected or untrusted interfaces. This prevents rogue devices from behaving as DHCP Servers. IP Source Guard (IPSG) When IP Source Guard is enabled at a port, the switch filters out IP packets received from the port if the source IP addresses of the packets have not been statically configured or dynamically learned from DHCP snooping. This prevents IP address spoofing. Dynamic ARP Inspection (DAI) The switch discards ARP packets from a port if there are no static or dynamic IP/MAC bindings or if there is a discrepancy between the source or destination addresses in the ARP packet. This prevents man-in-the-middle attacks. IP/MAC/Port Binding (IPMB) The preceding features (DHCP Snooping, IP Source Guard, and Dynamic ARP Inspection) work together to prevent DOS attacks in the network, thereby increasing network availability Secure Core Technology (SCT) Makes sure that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plaintext or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user. Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Private VLAN Private VLAN provides security and isolation between switch ports, which helps ensure that users cannot snoop on other users’ traffic; supports multiple uplinks Layer 2 isolation Private VLAN Edge (PVE) PVE (also known as protected ports) provides Layer 2 isolation between devices in the same VLAN, supports multiple uplinks Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limits the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS/TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and TACACS authentication. Switch functions as a client RADIUS accounting The RADIUS accounting functions allow data to be sent at the start and end of services, indicating the amount of resources (such as time, packets, bytes, and so on) used during the session Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DOS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels ACLs Support for up to 1,024 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID, IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol/User Datagram Protocol (TCP/UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported Quality of ServicePriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and remarking ACLs, trusted QoS Queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based; 2R3C policing Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to minimize and prevent global TCP loss synchronization iSCSI traffic optimization A mechanism for giving priority to iSCSI traffic over other types of traffic Standards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ae 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over fiber for LAN, IEEE 802.3an 10GBase-T 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over copper twisted pair cable, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w Rapid STP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, IEEE 802.1AB Link Layer Discovery Protocol, IEEE 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 826, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3176, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode; IPv6 over Ethernet; Dual IPv6/IPv4 stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND); IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration; Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD); ICMP version 6 DHCPv6 stateful client IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) tunnel support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 First Hop Security RA guard ND inspection DHCPv6 guard Neighbor binding table (snooping and static entries) Neighbor binding integrity check Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers MLD proxy The MLD proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on MLD membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, ping, traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), SNMP, RADIUS, syslog, Domain Name System (DNS) client, Telnet Client, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, IPv6 DHCP Relay, Terminal Access Controller Access Control System Plus (TACACS+) IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463): ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration RFC 1981: path MTU discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484: default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: MIB IPv6: textual conventions and general group RFC 3595: textual conventions for IPv6 flow label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports simple and advanced mode, configuration, wizards, customizable dashboard, system maintenance, monitoring, online help, and universal search SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port. Flow-based redirection and mirroring Redirect or mirror traffic to a destination port or mirroring session based on flow Remote Switch Port Analyzer (RSPAN) Traffic can be mirrored across Layer 2 domain to a remote port on a different switch for easier troubleshooting sFlow agent Switch can export sFlow sample to external collectors. sFlow provides visibility into network traffic down to flow level DHCP (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 82, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfer files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with Secure Copy (SCP) file download Enables secure mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartport roles and applies it automatically to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments Textview CLI Scriptable command-line interface. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; SSH; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; BOOTP; SNTP; Xmodem upgrade; cable diagnostics; ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables. EEE Compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 16K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics via Cisco Discovery Protocol Power over Ethernet802.3af PoE, 802.3at PoE+ or 60W PoE delivered over the RJ-45 ports within the listed power budgets The following switches support 802.3at PoE+, 802.3af, and Cisco prestandard (legacy) PoE. 60W PoE is also supported on select RJ-45 network ports on select models. The total power available for PoE per switch is as follows: Power dedicated to PoE 740 W Number of Ports That Support PoE 48 Hardware Power Consumption (worst case)System power consumption 110V=60.77W 220V=59.73 Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=451.95W 220V=445.85W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 1542.12 PortsTotal system ports 52 x Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 48 x Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 4 x SFP Console port Cisco standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer (All numbers are aggregate across all ports as the buffers are dynamically shared:) 3 MB Supported SFP modulesSKU Media MGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP cat 5e GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 445 x 350 x 44 mm (17.5 x 13.78 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 5.43 kg (11.97 lb) Power 100-240V 50-60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C) Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C:37.3 dBA MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 856329 Warranty Limited lifetime with next business day advance replacement Package contents Cisco Business 350 Series Managed Switch Power cord Mounting Kit Quick Start Guide Minimum Requirements Web browser: Chrome, Firefox, Edge, Safari Category 5e Ethernet network cable TCP/IP, network adapter, and network operating system (such as Microsoft Windows, Linux, or Mac OS X) installed (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS350-48FP-4G-UK (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 740W) - REFRESH , Static abyss: labyrinth of veins - cd (0801056894625)

Cisco switch CBS350-48P-4X-UK (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, 48xPoE+, 370W) - REFRESH

Detail

Cisco switch CBS350-48P-4X-UK - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu UK = produkt určený pro trh v Anglii identický produkt k EU modelům s rozdílem napájecího kabelu pro UK, náhradní kabel CAB-TA-EU je součástí objednávky Řízené switche řady Cisco Business 350 jsou spolehlivými stavebními prvky pro sítě malých firem. Díky intuitivnímu ovládacímu panelu, pokročilým funkcím a všudypřítomnému zabezpečení urychlují spravované switche řady Cisco Business 350 vaši digitální transformaci. Záruka platná do End of Support 31. 10. 2029. Oznámení End of Life pro CISCO CBS350 Stránky produktu: CBS350-48P-4X-EU Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity and forwarding rate (All switches are wire speed and nonblocking)Capacity in Millions of Packets per Second (mpps) (64-byte packets) 130,94 Switching Capacity in Gigabits per Second (Gbps) 176 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+) and Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation VLAN Support for up to 4,094 VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs; MAC-based VLAN; protocol-based VLAN; IP subnet-based VLAN Management VLAN Private VLAN with promiscuous, isolated, and community port Private VLAN Edge (PVE), also known as protected ports, with multiple uplinks Guest VLAN, unauthenticated VLAN Dynamic VLAN assignment via RADIUS server along with 802.1x client authentication CPE VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers network wide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Multicast TV VLAN Multicast TV VLAN allows the single multicast VLAN to be shared in the network while subscribers remain in separate VLANs. This feature is also known as Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR) VLAN Translation Support for VLAN One-to-One Mapping. In VLAN One-to-One Mapping, on an edge interface customer VLANs (C-VLANs) are mapped to service provider VLANs (S-VLANs) and the original C-VLAN tags are replaced by the specified S-VLAN Q-in-Q VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Selective Q-in-Q Selective Q-in-Q is an enhancement to the basic Q-in-Q feature and provides, per edge interface, multiple mappings of different C-VLANs to separate S-VLANs Selective Q-in-Q also allows configuring of Ethertype (Tag Protocol Identifier [TPID]) of the S-VLAN tag Layer 2 protocol tunneling over Q-in-Q is also supported Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP)/Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) enable automatic propagation and configuration of VLANs in a bridged domain Unidirectional Link Detection (UDLD) UDLD monitors physical connection to detect unidirectional links caused by incorrect wiring or cable/port faults to prevent forwarding loops and black holing of traffic in switched networks Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) Relay at Layer 2 Relay of DHCP traffic to DHCP server in different VLAN; works with DHCP Option 82 Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) versions 1, 2, and 3 snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 2K multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP Querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router IGMP proxy The IGMP proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on IGMP membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Loopback Detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP Layer 3IPv4 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 990 static routes and up to 128 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 Interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, Link Aggregation (LAG), VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for classless interdomain routing RIP v2 Support for Routing Information Protocol version 2 for dynamic routing Policy-Based Routing (PBR) Flexible routing control to direct packets to different next hop based on IPv4 or IPv6 Access Control List (ACL) DHCP Server Switch functions as an IPv4 DHCP server serving IP addresses for multiple DHCP pools/scopes Support for DHCP options DHCP relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP)/DHCP packets StackingHardware stacking Up to 4 units in a stack. Up to 200 ports managed as a single system with hardware failover High availability Fast stack failover delivers minimal traffic loss. Support link aggregation across multiple units in a stack Plug-and-play stacking configuration/management Active/standby for resilient stack control Autonumbering Hot swap of units in stack Ring and chain stacking options, auto stacking port speed, flexible stacking port options High-speed stack interconnects Cost-effective high-speed 10G fiber interfaces. Securityecure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy Protocol (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch IEEE 802.1X (Authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication and accounting, MD5 hash; guest VLAN; unauthenticated VLAN, single/multiple host mode and single/multiple sessions Supports time-based 802.1X; dynamic VLAN assignment; MAC authentication IEEE 802.1X supplicant A switch can be configured to act as a supplicant to another switch. This enables extended secure access in areas outside the wiring closet (such as conference rooms) Web-based authentication Web-based authentication provides network admission control through web browser to any host devices and operating systems STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard A security mechanism to protect the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. This avoids accidental topology loops STP Root Guard This prevents edge devices not in the network administrator’s control from becoming Spanning Tree Protocol root nodes STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) DHCP snooping Filters out DHCP messages with unregistered IP addresses and/or from unexpected or untrusted interfaces. This prevents rogue devices from behaving as DHCP Servers. IP Source Guard (IPSG) When IP Source Guard is enabled at a port, the switch filters out IP packets received from the port if the source IP addresses of the packets have not been statically configured or dynamically learned from DHCP snooping. This prevents IP address spoofing. Dynamic ARP Inspection (DAI) The switch discards ARP packets from a port if there are no static or dynamic IP/MAC bindings or if there is a discrepancy between the source or destination addresses in the ARP packet. This prevents man-in-the-middle attacks. IP/MAC/Port Binding (IPMB) The preceding features (DHCP Snooping, IP Source Guard, and Dynamic ARP Inspection) work together to prevent DOS attacks in the network, thereby increasing network availability Secure Core Technology (SCT) Makes sure that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plaintext or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user. Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Private VLAN Private VLAN provides security and isolation between switch ports, which helps ensure that users cannot snoop on other users’ traffic; supports multiple uplinks Layer 2 isolation Private VLAN Edge (PVE) PVE (also known as protected ports) provides Layer 2 isolation between devices in the same VLAN, supports multiple uplinks Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limits the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS/TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and TACACS authentication. Switch functions as a client RADIUS accounting The RADIUS accounting functions allow data to be sent at the start and end of services, indicating the amount of resources (such as time, packets, bytes, and so on) used during the session Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DOS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels ACLs Support for up to 1,024 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID, IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol/User Datagram Protocol (TCP/UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported Quality of ServicePriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and remarking ACLs, trusted QoS Queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based; 2R3C policing Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to minimize and prevent global TCP loss synchronization iSCSI traffic optimization A mechanism for giving priority to iSCSI traffic over other types of traffic Standards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ae 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over fiber for LAN, IEEE 802.3an 10GBase-T 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over copper twisted pair cable, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w Rapid STP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, IEEE 802.1AB Link Layer Discovery Protocol, IEEE 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 826, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3176, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode; IPv6 over Ethernet; Dual IPv6/IPv4 stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND); IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration; Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD); ICMP version 6 DHCPv6 stateful client IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) tunnel support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 First Hop Security RA guard ND inspection DHCPv6 guard Neighbor binding table (snooping and static entries) Neighbor binding integrity check Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers MLD proxy The MLD proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on MLD membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, ping, traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), SNMP, RADIUS, syslog, Domain Name System (DNS) client, Telnet Client, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, IPv6 DHCP Relay, Terminal Access Controller Access Control System Plus (TACACS+) IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463): ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration RFC 1981: path MTU discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484: default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: MIB IPv6: textual conventions and general group RFC 3595: textual conventions for IPv6 flow label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports simple and advanced mode, configuration, wizards, customizable dashboard, system maintenance, monitoring, online help, and universal search SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port. Flow-based redirection and mirroring Redirect or mirror traffic to a destination port or mirroring session based on flow Remote Switch Port Analyzer (RSPAN) Traffic can be mirrored across Layer 2 domain to a remote port on a different switch for easier troubleshooting sFlow agent Switch can export sFlow sample to external collectors. sFlow provides visibility into network traffic down to flow level DHCP (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 82, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfer files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with Secure Copy (SCP) file download Enables secure mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartport roles and applies it automatically to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments Textview CLI Scriptable command-line interface. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; SSH; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; BOOTP; SNTP; Xmodem upgrade; cable diagnostics; ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables. EEE Compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 16K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics via Cisco Discovery Protocol Power over Ethernet802.3af PoE, 802.3at PoE+ or 60W PoE delivered over the RJ-45 ports within the listed power budgets The following switches support 802.3at PoE+, 802.3af, and Cisco prestandard (legacy) PoE. 60W PoE is also supported on select RJ-45 network ports on select models. The total power available for PoE per switch is as follows: Power dedicated to PoE 370 W Number of Ports That Support PoE 48 Hardware Power Consumption (worst case)System power consumption 110V=61.53W 220V=60.73 Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=471.90W 220V=463.32W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 1610.19 PortsTotal system ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet + 4 x 10G RJ-45 ports 48 x Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 4 x SFP+ Console port Cisco standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer (All numbers are aggregate across all ports as the buffers are dynamically shared:) 3 MB Supported SFP modulesSKU Media MGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP cat 5e GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e SFP-H10GB-CU1M Copper coax SFP-H10GB-CU3M Copper coax SFP-H10GB-CU5M Copper coax SFP-10G-SR Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR Single-mode fiber SFP-10G-SR-S Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR-S Single-mode fiber EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 445 x 350 x 44 mm (17.5 x 13.78 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 5.43 kg (11.97 lb) Power 100-240V 50-60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C) Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C:37.3 dBA MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 856329 Warranty Limited lifetime with next business day advance replacement Package contents Cisco Business 350 Series Managed Switch Power cord Mounting Kit Quick Start Guide Minimum Requirements Web browser: Chrome, Firefox, Edge, Safari Category 5e Ethernet network cable TCP/IP, network adapter, and network operating system (such as Microsoft Windows, Linux, or Mac OS X) installed (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS350-48P-4X-UK (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, 48xPoE+, 370W) - REFRESH , Ifixit portable anti-static mat (eu145202-5)

Cisco switch CBS350-48FP-4G-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 740W) - REFRESH

Detail

Cisco switch CBS350-48FP-4G Produktový kód: CBS350-48FP-4G EAN: 889728497534 Popis produktu Switch Cisco CBS350-48FP-4G je součástí programu REFRESH. To znamená, že je to opravené zařízení nebo zařízení z kvartálových rotací. Ale nebojte, disponuje stejnými funkcemi, podporou a zárukou, jako zařízení zcela nová. Výhody Cisco Business 350 Series Intuitivní ovládání pro automatizaci nasazení, monitorování a správu životnosti switchů. Rozsáhlé zabezpečení chránící Vaši síť a soukromí Vašich zákazníků. Gigabitový Ethernet a 10GE uplink pro rychlou přenosovou rychlost. Flexibilita díky možnosti spojení až čtyř samostatných switchů, fungující jako jedno zařízení s jednotnou správou a kontrolou. Technické specifikace Počet portů: 52 Provedení: Rack-mount Porty: 48x GbE, 4x SFP, PoE+ Výkon: Switching capacity: 104.0 Gbps, Forwarding performance (64-byte packet size): 77.38 Mpps VLAN: Ano Protokol pro vzdálenou správu: SNMP, RMON, HTTP, HTTPS, TFTP, Telnet, SSH Standardy: IEEE 802.3, IEEE 802.3u, IEEE 802.3ab, IEEE 802.3ad, IEEE 802.3z, IEEE 802.3ae, IEEE 802.3an, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w Rapid STP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, IEEE 802.1AB Link Layer Discovery Protocol, IEEE 802.3az Velikost MAC tabulky: 16 000 RAM: 512 MB Flash: 256 MB Napájení: 100-240 V (50-60 Hz), interní Rozměry (Š x V x H): 445 x 350 x 44 mm Hmotnost: 5.82 kg Provozní teplota: -5 až 50°C Provozní vlhost: 10 - 90% Skladovací teplota: -25 až 70 °C (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS350-48FP-4G-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 740W) - REFRESH , Madcat a-static clonk teaser 150g (ryb014823nad)

Cisco switch CBS250-48P-4G-UK (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 370W) - REFRESH

Cisco switch CBS250-48P-4G-UK (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 370W) - REFRESH
Detail

Cisco switch CBS250-48P-4G-UK - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu UK = produkt určený pro trh v Anglii identický produkt k EU modelům s rozdílem napájecího kabelu pro UK, náhradní kabel CAB-TA-EU je součástí objednávky Řada Cisco Business 250 představuje novou generaci cenově dostupných inteligentních switchů, které kombinují vysoký síťový výkon, zabezpečení a spolehlivost s komplexní sadou síťových funkcí potřebných pro spolehlivou síť malých firem. Záruka platná do End of Support 31. 10. 2029. Oznámení End of Life pro CISCO CBS250 Stránky produktu: CBS250-48P-4G Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity (All switches are wire-speed and nonblocking)Forwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 77,38 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 104 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d spanning tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple spanning tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+); 126 instances are supported Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 4 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad Link Aggregation Group (LAG) VLAN Support for up to 255 active VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers networkwide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain IGMP (versions 1, 2, and 3) snooping Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 255 multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP querier Used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router HOL blocking Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking prevention Loopback detection Provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Layer 3 routingIPv4 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 32 static routes and up to 16 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, LAG, VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for CIDR Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BootP)/DHCP packets SecuritySecure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication, guest VLAN, single/multiple host mode, and single/multiple sessions STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) Secure Core Technology (SCT) Ensures that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plain text or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limit the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS Supports RADIUS authentication for management access. Switch functions as a client. Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DoS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels Access Control Lists (ACLs) Support for up to 512 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, TCP/UDP source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.3 ad LACP, IEEE 802.1D (STP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 Neighbor Discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) version 6 IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, Ping, Traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP), Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS), Syslog, DNS client, DHCP client, DHCP autoconfig IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC 2463): ICMPv6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 Addressing Architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 Specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): Neighbor Discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 Stateless Address Autoconfiguration RFC 1981: Path MTU Discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 Scoped Address Architecture RFC 3484: Default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: Management Information Base (MIB) IPv6: Textual Conventions and General Group RFC 3595: Textual Conventions for IPv6 Flow Label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, wizards, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Basic and advanced mode for maximum operational efficiency SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP v3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server), to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP Relay, and host name Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfers files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with SCP file download Enables mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable configs Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Automatically applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartports roles to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments. Text view Command-Line Interface (CLI) Scriptable CLI. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI. Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP); cable diagnostics; Ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link is up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables EEE compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 8K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics using Cisco Discovery Protocol Power over Ethernet802.3at PoE+ and 802.3af PoE delivered over any of the RJ-45 ports within the listed power budgets The following switches support 802.3at PoE+, 802.3af, and Cisco prestandard (legacy) PoE. Maximum power of 30.0W to any 10/100 or Gigabit Ethernet port, until the PoE budget for the switch is reached. The total power available for PoE per switch is as follows: Power dedicated to PoE 370 W Number of ports that support PoE 48 Hardware Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=60.77W 220V=59.73W Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=451.95W 220V=445.85W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 1542.12 PortsTotal system ports 52 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 4 SFP Console port Cisco Standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer 3 MB Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 445 x 350 x 44 mm (17.5 x 13.78 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 5.43 kg (11.97 lb) Power 100 to 240V 50 to 60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C: 37.3 dBA MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 856329 Warranty Limited lifetime Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 250 Series Smart Switch Power cord Mounting kit Quick start guide (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS250-48P-4G-UK (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 370W) - REFRESH , Netgear axlc763 (axlc763-10000s)

Cisco switch CBS350-48FP-4X-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, 48xPoE+, 740W) - REFRESH

Cisco switch CBS350-48FP-4X-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, 48xPoE+, 740W) - REFRESH
Detail

Cisco switch CBS350-48FP-4X-EU - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu Řízené switche řady Cisco Business 350 jsou spolehlivými stavebními prvky pro sítě malých firem. Díky intuitivnímu ovládacímu panelu, pokročilým funkcím a všudypřítomnému zabezpečení urychlují spravované switche řady Cisco Business 350 vaši digitální transformaci. Záruka platná do End of Support 31. 10. 2029. Oznámení End of Life pro CISCO CBS350 Stránky produktu: CBS350-48FP-4X-EU Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity and forwarding rate (All switches are wire speed and nonblocking)Capacity in Millions of Packets per Second (mpps) (64-byte packets) 130,94 Switching Capacity in Gigabits per Second (Gbps) 176 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+) and Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation VLAN Support for up to 4,094 VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs; MAC-based VLAN; protocol-based VLAN; IP subnet-based VLAN Management VLAN Private VLAN with promiscuous, isolated, and community port Private VLAN Edge (PVE), also known as protected ports, with multiple uplinks Guest VLAN, unauthenticated VLAN Dynamic VLAN assignment via RADIUS server along with 802.1x client authentication CPE VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers network wide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Multicast TV VLAN Multicast TV VLAN allows the single multicast VLAN to be shared in the network while subscribers remain in separate VLANs. This feature is also known as Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR) VLAN Translation Support for VLAN One-to-One Mapping. In VLAN One-to-One Mapping, on an edge interface customer VLANs (C-VLANs) are mapped to service provider VLANs (S-VLANs) and the original C-VLAN tags are replaced by the specified S-VLAN Q-in-Q VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Selective Q-in-Q Selective Q-in-Q is an enhancement to the basic Q-in-Q feature and provides, per edge interface, multiple mappings of different C-VLANs to separate S-VLANs Selective Q-in-Q also allows configuring of Ethertype (Tag Protocol Identifier [TPID]) of the S-VLAN tag Layer 2 protocol tunneling over Q-in-Q is also supported Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP)/Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) enable automatic propagation and configuration of VLANs in a bridged domain Unidirectional Link Detection (UDLD) UDLD monitors physical connection to detect unidirectional links caused by incorrect wiring or cable/port faults to prevent forwarding loops and black holing of traffic in switched networks Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) Relay at Layer 2 Relay of DHCP traffic to DHCP server in different VLAN; works with DHCP Option 82 Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) versions 1, 2, and 3 snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 2K multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP Querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router IGMP proxy The IGMP proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on IGMP membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Loopback Detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP Layer 3IPv4 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 990 static routes and up to 128 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 Interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, Link Aggregation (LAG), VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for classless interdomain routing RIP v2 Support for Routing Information Protocol version 2 for dynamic routing Policy-Based Routing (PBR) Flexible routing control to direct packets to different next hop based on IPv4 or IPv6 Access Control List (ACL) DHCP Server Switch functions as an IPv4 DHCP server serving IP addresses for multiple DHCP pools/scopes Support for DHCP options DHCP relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP)/DHCP packets StackingHardware stacking Up to 4 units in a stack. Up to 200 ports managed as a single system with hardware failover High availability Fast stack failover delivers minimal traffic loss. Support link aggregation across multiple units in a stack Plug-and-play stacking configuration/management Active/standby for resilient stack control Autonumbering Hot swap of units in stack Ring and chain stacking options, auto stacking port speed, flexible stacking port options High-speed stack interconnects Cost-effective high-speed 10G fiber interfaces. Securityecure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy Protocol (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch IEEE 802.1X (Authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication and accounting, MD5 hash; guest VLAN; unauthenticated VLAN, single/multiple host mode and single/multiple sessions Supports time-based 802.1X; dynamic VLAN assignment; MAC authentication IEEE 802.1X supplicant A switch can be configured to act as a supplicant to another switch. This enables extended secure access in areas outside the wiring closet (such as conference rooms) Web-based authentication Web-based authentication provides network admission control through web browser to any host devices and operating systems STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard A security mechanism to protect the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. This avoids accidental topology loops STP Root Guard This prevents edge devices not in the network administrator’s control from becoming Spanning Tree Protocol root nodes STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) DHCP snooping Filters out DHCP messages with unregistered IP addresses and/or from unexpected or untrusted interfaces. This prevents rogue devices from behaving as DHCP Servers. IP Source Guard (IPSG) When IP Source Guard is enabled at a port, the switch filters out IP packets received from the port if the source IP addresses of the packets have not been statically configured or dynamically learned from DHCP snooping. This prevents IP address spoofing. Dynamic ARP Inspection (DAI) The switch discards ARP packets from a port if there are no static or dynamic IP/MAC bindings or if there is a discrepancy between the source or destination addresses in the ARP packet. This prevents man-in-the-middle attacks. IP/MAC/Port Binding (IPMB) The preceding features (DHCP Snooping, IP Source Guard, and Dynamic ARP Inspection) work together to prevent DOS attacks in the network, thereby increasing network availability Secure Core Technology (SCT) Makes sure that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plaintext or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user. Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Private VLAN Private VLAN provides security and isolation between switch ports, which helps ensure that users cannot snoop on other users’ traffic; supports multiple uplinks Layer 2 isolation Private VLAN Edge (PVE) PVE (also known as protected ports) provides Layer 2 isolation between devices in the same VLAN, supports multiple uplinks Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limits the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS/TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and TACACS authentication. Switch functions as a client RADIUS accounting The RADIUS accounting functions allow data to be sent at the start and end of services, indicating the amount of resources (such as time, packets, bytes, and so on) used during the session Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DOS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels ACLs Support for up to 1,024 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID, IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol/User Datagram Protocol (TCP/UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported Quality of ServicePriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and remarking ACLs, trusted QoS Queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based; 2R3C policing Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to minimize and prevent global TCP loss synchronization iSCSI traffic optimization A mechanism for giving priority to iSCSI traffic over other types of traffic Standards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ae 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over fiber for LAN, IEEE 802.3an 10GBase-T 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over copper twisted pair cable, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w Rapid STP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, IEEE 802.1AB Link Layer Discovery Protocol, IEEE 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 826, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3176, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode; IPv6 over Ethernet; Dual IPv6/IPv4 stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND); IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration; Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD); ICMP version 6 DHCPv6 stateful client IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) tunnel support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 First Hop Security RA guard ND inspection DHCPv6 guard Neighbor binding table (snooping and static entries) Neighbor binding integrity check Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers MLD proxy The MLD proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on MLD membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, ping, traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), SNMP, RADIUS, syslog, Domain Name System (DNS) client, Telnet Client, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, IPv6 DHCP Relay, Terminal Access Controller Access Control System Plus (TACACS+) IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463): ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration RFC 1981: path MTU discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484: default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: MIB IPv6: textual conventions and general group RFC 3595: textual conventions for IPv6 flow label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports simple and advanced mode, configuration, wizards, customizable dashboard, system maintenance, monitoring, online help, and universal search SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port. Flow-based redirection and mirroring Redirect or mirror traffic to a destination port or mirroring session based on flow Remote Switch Port Analyzer (RSPAN) Traffic can be mirrored across Layer 2 domain to a remote port on a different switch for easier troubleshooting sFlow agent Switch can export sFlow sample to external collectors. sFlow provides visibility into network traffic down to flow level DHCP (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 82, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfer files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with Secure Copy (SCP) file download Enables secure mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartport roles and applies it automatically to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments Textview CLI Scriptable command-line interface. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; SSH; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; BOOTP; SNTP; Xmodem upgrade; cable diagnostics; ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables. EEE Compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 16K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics via Cisco Discovery Protocol Power over Ethernet802.3af PoE, 802.3at PoE+ or 60W PoE delivered over the RJ-45 ports within the listed power budgets The following switches support 802.3at PoE+, 802.3af, and Cisco prestandard (legacy) PoE. 60W PoE is also supported on select RJ-45 network ports on select models. The total power available for PoE per switch is as follows: Power dedicated to PoE 740 W Number of Ports That Support PoE 48 Hardware Power Consumption (worst case)System power consumption 110V=76.18W 220V=76.22 Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=889.35W 220V=865.02W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 3034.59 PortsTotal system ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet + 4 x 10G RJ-45 ports 48 x Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 4 x SFP+ Console port Cisco standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer (All numbers are aggregate across all ports as the buffers are dynamically shared:) 3 MB Supported SFP modulesSKU Media MGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP cat 5e GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e SFP-H10GB-CU1M Copper coax SFP-H10GB-CU3M Copper coax SFP-H10GB-CU5M Copper coax SFP-10G-SR Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR Single-mode fiber SFP-10G-SR-S Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR-S Single-mode fiber EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 445 x 350 x 44 mm (17.5 x 13.78 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 5.82 kg (12.83 lb) Power 100-240V 50-60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C) Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C:48.7 dBA MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 856301 Warranty Limited lifetime with next business day advance replacement Package contents Cisco Business 350 Series Managed Switch Power cord Mounting Kit Quick Start Guide Minimum Requirements Web browser: Chrome, Firefox, Edge, Safari Category 5e Ethernet network cable TCP/IP, network adapter, and network operating system (such as Microsoft Windows, Linux, or Mac OS X) installed (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS350-48FP-4X-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, 48xPoE+, 740W) - REFRESH , Netgear gs308pp (gs308pp-100eus)

Cisco switch CBS350-48P-4X-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, 48xPoE+, 370W) - REFRESH

Cisco switch CBS350-48P-4X-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, 48xPoE+, 370W) - REFRESH
Detail

Cisco switch CBS350-48P-4X-EU - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu Řízené switche řady Cisco Business 350 jsou spolehlivými stavebními prvky pro sítě malých firem. Díky intuitivnímu ovládacímu panelu, pokročilým funkcím a všudypřítomnému zabezpečení urychlují spravované switche řady Cisco Business 350 vaši digitální transformaci. Záruka platná do End of Support 31. 10. 2029. Oznámení End of Life pro CISCO CBS350 Stránky produktu: CBS350-48P-4X-EU Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity and forwarding rate (All switches are wire speed and nonblocking)Capacity in Millions of Packets per Second (mpps) (64-byte packets) 130,94 Switching Capacity in Gigabits per Second (Gbps) 176 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+) and Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation VLAN Support for up to 4,094 VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs; MAC-based VLAN; protocol-based VLAN; IP subnet-based VLAN Management VLAN Private VLAN with promiscuous, isolated, and community port Private VLAN Edge (PVE), also known as protected ports, with multiple uplinks Guest VLAN, unauthenticated VLAN Dynamic VLAN assignment via RADIUS server along with 802.1x client authentication CPE VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers network wide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Multicast TV VLAN Multicast TV VLAN allows the single multicast VLAN to be shared in the network while subscribers remain in separate VLANs. This feature is also known as Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR) VLAN Translation Support for VLAN One-to-One Mapping. In VLAN One-to-One Mapping, on an edge interface customer VLANs (C-VLANs) are mapped to service provider VLANs (S-VLANs) and the original C-VLAN tags are replaced by the specified S-VLAN Q-in-Q VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Selective Q-in-Q Selective Q-in-Q is an enhancement to the basic Q-in-Q feature and provides, per edge interface, multiple mappings of different C-VLANs to separate S-VLANs Selective Q-in-Q also allows configuring of Ethertype (Tag Protocol Identifier [TPID]) of the S-VLAN tag Layer 2 protocol tunneling over Q-in-Q is also supported Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP)/Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) enable automatic propagation and configuration of VLANs in a bridged domain Unidirectional Link Detection (UDLD) UDLD monitors physical connection to detect unidirectional links caused by incorrect wiring or cable/port faults to prevent forwarding loops and black holing of traffic in switched networks Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) Relay at Layer 2 Relay of DHCP traffic to DHCP server in different VLAN; works with DHCP Option 82 Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) versions 1, 2, and 3 snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 2K multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP Querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router IGMP proxy The IGMP proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on IGMP membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Loopback Detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP Layer 3IPv4 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 990 static routes and up to 128 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 Interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, Link Aggregation (LAG), VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for classless interdomain routing RIP v2 Support for Routing Information Protocol version 2 for dynamic routing Policy-Based Routing (PBR) Flexible routing control to direct packets to different next hop based on IPv4 or IPv6 Access Control List (ACL) DHCP Server Switch functions as an IPv4 DHCP server serving IP addresses for multiple DHCP pools/scopes Support for DHCP options DHCP relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP)/DHCP packets StackingHardware stacking Up to 4 units in a stack. Up to 200 ports managed as a single system with hardware failover High availability Fast stack failover delivers minimal traffic loss. Support link aggregation across multiple units in a stack Plug-and-play stacking configuration/management Active/standby for resilient stack control Autonumbering Hot swap of units in stack Ring and chain stacking options, auto stacking port speed, flexible stacking port options High-speed stack interconnects Cost-effective high-speed 10G fiber interfaces. Securityecure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy Protocol (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch IEEE 802.1X (Authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication and accounting, MD5 hash; guest VLAN; unauthenticated VLAN, single/multiple host mode and single/multiple sessions Supports time-based 802.1X; dynamic VLAN assignment; MAC authentication IEEE 802.1X supplicant A switch can be configured to act as a supplicant to another switch. This enables extended secure access in areas outside the wiring closet (such as conference rooms) Web-based authentication Web-based authentication provides network admission control through web browser to any host devices and operating systems STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard A security mechanism to protect the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. This avoids accidental topology loops STP Root Guard This prevents edge devices not in the network administrator’s control from becoming Spanning Tree Protocol root nodes STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) DHCP snooping Filters out DHCP messages with unregistered IP addresses and/or from unexpected or untrusted interfaces. This prevents rogue devices from behaving as DHCP Servers. IP Source Guard (IPSG) When IP Source Guard is enabled at a port, the switch filters out IP packets received from the port if the source IP addresses of the packets have not been statically configured or dynamically learned from DHCP snooping. This prevents IP address spoofing. Dynamic ARP Inspection (DAI) The switch discards ARP packets from a port if there are no static or dynamic IP/MAC bindings or if there is a discrepancy between the source or destination addresses in the ARP packet. This prevents man-in-the-middle attacks. IP/MAC/Port Binding (IPMB) The preceding features (DHCP Snooping, IP Source Guard, and Dynamic ARP Inspection) work together to prevent DOS attacks in the network, thereby increasing network availability Secure Core Technology (SCT) Makes sure that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plaintext or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user. Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Private VLAN Private VLAN provides security and isolation between switch ports, which helps ensure that users cannot snoop on other users’ traffic; supports multiple uplinks Layer 2 isolation Private VLAN Edge (PVE) PVE (also known as protected ports) provides Layer 2 isolation between devices in the same VLAN, supports multiple uplinks Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limits the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS/TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and TACACS authentication. Switch functions as a client RADIUS accounting The RADIUS accounting functions allow data to be sent at the start and end of services, indicating the amount of resources (such as time, packets, bytes, and so on) used during the session Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DOS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels ACLs Support for up to 1,024 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID, IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol/User Datagram Protocol (TCP/UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported Quality of ServicePriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and remarking ACLs, trusted QoS Queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based; 2R3C policing Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to minimize and prevent global TCP loss synchronization iSCSI traffic optimization A mechanism for giving priority to iSCSI traffic over other types of traffic Standards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ae 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over fiber for LAN, IEEE 802.3an 10GBase-T 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over copper twisted pair cable, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w Rapid STP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, IEEE 802.1AB Link Layer Discovery Protocol, IEEE 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 826, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3176, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode; IPv6 over Ethernet; Dual IPv6/IPv4 stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND); IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration; Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD); ICMP version 6 DHCPv6 stateful client IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) tunnel support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 First Hop Security RA guard ND inspection DHCPv6 guard Neighbor binding table (snooping and static entries) Neighbor binding integrity check Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers MLD proxy The MLD proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on MLD membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, ping, traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), SNMP, RADIUS, syslog, Domain Name System (DNS) client, Telnet Client, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, IPv6 DHCP Relay, Terminal Access Controller Access Control System Plus (TACACS+) IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463): ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration RFC 1981: path MTU discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484: default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: MIB IPv6: textual conventions and general group RFC 3595: textual conventions for IPv6 flow label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports simple and advanced mode, configuration, wizards, customizable dashboard, system maintenance, monitoring, online help, and universal search SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port. Flow-based redirection and mirroring Redirect or mirror traffic to a destination port or mirroring session based on flow Remote Switch Port Analyzer (RSPAN) Traffic can be mirrored across Layer 2 domain to a remote port on a different switch for easier troubleshooting sFlow agent Switch can export sFlow sample to external collectors. sFlow provides visibility into network traffic down to flow level DHCP (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 82, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfer files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with Secure Copy (SCP) file download Enables secure mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartport roles and applies it automatically to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments Textview CLI Scriptable command-line interface. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; SSH; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; BOOTP; SNTP; Xmodem upgrade; cable diagnostics; ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables. EEE Compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 16K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics via Cisco Discovery Protocol Power over Ethernet802.3af PoE, 802.3at PoE+ or 60W PoE delivered over the RJ-45 ports within the listed power budgets The following switches support 802.3at PoE+, 802.3af, and Cisco prestandard (legacy) PoE. 60W PoE is also supported on select RJ-45 network ports on select models. The total power available for PoE per switch is as follows: Power dedicated to PoE 370 W Number of Ports That Support PoE 48 Hardware Power Consumption (worst case)System power consumption 110V=61.53W 220V=60.73 Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=471.90W 220V=463.32W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 1610.19 PortsTotal system ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet + 4 x 10G RJ-45 ports 48 x Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 4 x SFP+ Console port Cisco standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer (All numbers are aggregate across all ports as the buffers are dynamically shared:) 3 MB Supported SFP modulesSKU Media MGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP cat 5e GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e SFP-H10GB-CU1M Copper coax SFP-H10GB-CU3M Copper coax SFP-H10GB-CU5M Copper coax SFP-10G-SR Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR Single-mode fiber SFP-10G-SR-S Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR-S Single-mode fiber EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 445 x 350 x 44 mm (17.5 x 13.78 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 5.43 kg (11.97 lb) Power 100-240V 50-60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C) Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C:37.3 dBA MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 856329 Warranty Limited lifetime with next business day advance replacement Package contents Cisco Business 350 Series Managed Switch Power cord Mounting Kit Quick Start Guide Minimum Requirements Web browser: Chrome, Firefox, Edge, Safari Category 5e Ethernet network cable TCP/IP, network adapter, and network operating system (such as Microsoft Windows, Linux, or Mac OS X) installed (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS350-48P-4X-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, 48xPoE+, 370W) - REFRESH , Netgear ex6130 (ex6130-100pes)

Cisco switch CBS350-48P-4G-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 370W) - REFRESH

Detail

Cisco switch CBS350-48P-4G-EU - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu Řízené switche řady Cisco Business 350 jsou spolehlivými stavebními prvky pro sítě malých firem. Díky intuitivnímu ovládacímu panelu, pokročilým funkcím a všudypřítomnému zabezpečení urychlují spravované switche řady Cisco Business 350 vaši digitální transformaci. Záruka platná do End of Support 31. 10. 2029. Oznámení End of Life pro CISCO CBS350 Stránky produktu: CBS350-48P-4G-EU Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity and forwarding rate (All switches are wire speed and nonblocking)Capacity in Millions of Packets per Second (mpps) (64-byte packets) 77,38 Switching Capacity in Gigabits per Second (Gbps) 104 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+) and Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation VLAN Support for up to 4,094 VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs; MAC-based VLAN; protocol-based VLAN; IP subnet-based VLAN Management VLAN Private VLAN with promiscuous, isolated, and community port Private VLAN Edge (PVE), also known as protected ports, with multiple uplinks Guest VLAN, unauthenticated VLAN Dynamic VLAN assignment via RADIUS server along with 802.1x client authentication CPE VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers network wide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Multicast TV VLAN Multicast TV VLAN allows the single multicast VLAN to be shared in the network while subscribers remain in separate VLANs. This feature is also known as Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR) VLAN Translation Support for VLAN One-to-One Mapping. In VLAN One-to-One Mapping, on an edge interface customer VLANs (C-VLANs) are mapped to service provider VLANs (S-VLANs) and the original C-VLAN tags are replaced by the specified S-VLAN Q-in-Q VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Selective Q-in-Q Selective Q-in-Q is an enhancement to the basic Q-in-Q feature and provides, per edge interface, multiple mappings of different C-VLANs to separate S-VLANs Selective Q-in-Q also allows configuring of Ethertype (Tag Protocol Identifier [TPID]) of the S-VLAN tag Layer 2 protocol tunneling over Q-in-Q is also supported Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP)/Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) enable automatic propagation and configuration of VLANs in a bridged domain Unidirectional Link Detection (UDLD) UDLD monitors physical connection to detect unidirectional links caused by incorrect wiring or cable/port faults to prevent forwarding loops and black holing of traffic in switched networks Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) Relay at Layer 2 Relay of DHCP traffic to DHCP server in different VLAN; works with DHCP Option 82 Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) versions 1, 2, and 3 snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 2K multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP Querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router IGMP proxy The IGMP proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on IGMP membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Loopback Detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP Layer 3IPv4 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 990 static routes and up to 128 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 Interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, Link Aggregation (LAG), VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for classless interdomain routing RIP v2 Support for Routing Information Protocol version 2 for dynamic routing Policy-Based Routing (PBR) Flexible routing control to direct packets to different next hop based on IPv4 or IPv6 Access Control List (ACL) DHCP Server Switch functions as an IPv4 DHCP server serving IP addresses for multiple DHCP pools/scopes Support for DHCP options DHCP relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP)/DHCP packets Securityecure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy Protocol (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch IEEE 802.1X (Authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication and accounting, MD5 hash; guest VLAN; unauthenticated VLAN, single/multiple host mode and single/multiple sessions Supports time-based 802.1X; dynamic VLAN assignment; MAC authentication IEEE 802.1X supplicant A switch can be configured to act as a supplicant to another switch. This enables extended secure access in areas outside the wiring closet (such as conference rooms) Web-based authentication Web-based authentication provides network admission control through web browser to any host devices and operating systems STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard A security mechanism to protect the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. This avoids accidental topology loops STP Root Guard This prevents edge devices not in the network administrator’s control from becoming Spanning Tree Protocol root nodes STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) DHCP snooping Filters out DHCP messages with unregistered IP addresses and/or from unexpected or untrusted interfaces. This prevents rogue devices from behaving as DHCP Servers. IP Source Guard (IPSG) When IP Source Guard is enabled at a port, the switch filters out IP packets received from the port if the source IP addresses of the packets have not been statically configured or dynamically learned from DHCP snooping. This prevents IP address spoofing. Dynamic ARP Inspection (DAI) The switch discards ARP packets from a port if there are no static or dynamic IP/MAC bindings or if there is a discrepancy between the source or destination addresses in the ARP packet. This prevents man-in-the-middle attacks. IP/MAC/Port Binding (IPMB) The preceding features (DHCP Snooping, IP Source Guard, and Dynamic ARP Inspection) work together to prevent DOS attacks in the network, thereby increasing network availability Secure Core Technology (SCT) Makes sure that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plaintext or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user. Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Private VLAN Private VLAN provides security and isolation between switch ports, which helps ensure that users cannot snoop on other users’ traffic; supports multiple uplinks Layer 2 isolation Private VLAN Edge (PVE) PVE (also known as protected ports) provides Layer 2 isolation between devices in the same VLAN, supports multiple uplinks Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limits the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS/TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and TACACS authentication. Switch functions as a client RADIUS accounting The RADIUS accounting functions allow data to be sent at the start and end of services, indicating the amount of resources (such as time, packets, bytes, and so on) used during the session Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DOS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels ACLs Support for up to 1,024 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID, IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol/User Datagram Protocol (TCP/UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported Quality of ServicePriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and remarking ACLs, trusted QoS Queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based; 2R3C policing Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to minimize and prevent global TCP loss synchronization iSCSI traffic optimization A mechanism for giving priority to iSCSI traffic over other types of traffic Standards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ae 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over fiber for LAN, IEEE 802.3an 10GBase-T 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over copper twisted pair cable, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w Rapid STP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, IEEE 802.1AB Link Layer Discovery Protocol, IEEE 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 826, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3176, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode; IPv6 over Ethernet; Dual IPv6/IPv4 stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND); IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration; Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD); ICMP version 6 DHCPv6 stateful client IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) tunnel support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 First Hop Security RA guard ND inspection DHCPv6 guard Neighbor binding table (snooping and static entries) Neighbor binding integrity check Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers MLD proxy The MLD proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on MLD membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, ping, traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), SNMP, RADIUS, syslog, Domain Name System (DNS) client, Telnet Client, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, IPv6 DHCP Relay, Terminal Access Controller Access Control System Plus (TACACS+) IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463): ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration RFC 1981: path MTU discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484: default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: MIB IPv6: textual conventions and general group RFC 3595: textual conventions for IPv6 flow label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports simple and advanced mode, configuration, wizards, customizable dashboard, system maintenance, monitoring, online help, and universal search SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port. Flow-based redirection and mirroring Redirect or mirror traffic to a destination port or mirroring session based on flow Remote Switch Port Analyzer (RSPAN) Traffic can be mirrored across Layer 2 domain to a remote port on a different switch for easier troubleshooting sFlow agent Switch can export sFlow sample to external collectors. sFlow provides visibility into network traffic down to flow level DHCP (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 82, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfer files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with Secure Copy (SCP) file download Enables secure mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartport roles and applies it automatically to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments Textview CLI Scriptable command-line interface. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; SSH; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; BOOTP; SNTP; Xmodem upgrade; cable diagnostics; ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables. EEE Compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 16K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics via Cisco Discovery Protocol Power over Ethernet802.3af PoE, 802.3at PoE+ or 60W PoE delivered over the RJ-45 ports within the listed power budgets The following switches support 802.3at PoE+, 802.3af, and Cisco prestandard (legacy) PoE. 60W PoE is also supported on select RJ-45 network ports on select models. The total power available for PoE per switch is as follows: Power dedicated to PoE 370 W Number of Ports That Support PoE 48 Hardware Power Consumption (worst case)System power consumption 110V=60.77W 220V=59.73 Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=451.95W 220V=445.85W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 1542.12 PortsTotal system ports 52 x Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 48 x Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 4 x SFP Console port Cisco standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer (All numbers are aggregate across all ports as the buffers are dynamically shared:) 3 MB Supported SFP modulesSKU Media MGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP cat 5e GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 445 x 350 x 44 mm (17.5 x 13.78 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 5.43 kg (11.97 lb) Power 100-240V 50-60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C) Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C:37.3 dBA MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 856329 Warranty Limited lifetime with next business day advance replacement Package contents Cisco Business 350 Series Managed Switch Power cord Mounting Kit Quick Start Guide Minimum Requirements Web browser: Chrome, Firefox, Edge, Safari Category 5e Ethernet network cable TCP/IP, network adapter, and network operating system (such as Microsoft Windows, Linux, or Mac OS X) installed (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS350-48P-4G-EU (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 370W) - REFRESH , Netgear a6210 (a6210-100pes)

TP-Link OMADA JetStream switch TL-SG3452P (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48x PoE+, 384W, 2xconsole)

TP-Link OMADA JetStream switch TL-SG3452P (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48x PoE+, 384W, 2xconsole)
Detail

TP-Link switch TL-SG3452P Popis produktu 52portový gigabitový L2+ řízený switch JetStream se 48 porty PoE+ Switch nabízí 48 gigabitových portů RJ45 a 4 porty SFP pro vysokorychlostní připojení. Disponuje také 48 porty PoE+ odpovídajících standardu 802.3at/af s celkovým výkonem 384 W. Integrace do Omada SDN Nabízí funkce ZTP (Zero-Touch Provisioning), centralizovaná cloudová správa a inteligentní monitorování. Centralizovaná správa Cloudový přístup a aplikace Omada pro maximální pohodlí a snadnou správu. Statické směrování Pomáhá směrovat tok dat po lokální síti, zajišťuje efektivní využití síťových prostředků. Robustní strategie zabezpečení IP-MAC vázání ACL Zabezpečení portů Ochrana proti útokům DoS Storm Control DHCP Snooping Ověřování protokolem 802.1X a Radius Optimalizovaný přenos hlasu a videa L2/L3/L4 QoS a funkce IGMP Snooping. Samostatná správa Webové rozhraní, CLI (konzolový port, Telnet, SSH), SNMP, RMON a funkce Dual Image přináší pokročilé možnosti správy. Technické specifikace Hardware 48× 10/100/1000 Mbps RJ45 Ports 4× Gigabit SFP Slots 1× RJ45 Console Port 1× Micro-USB Console Port 3 ventilátory Napájení: 100-240 V AC 50/60 Hz 48 PoE+ Ports s výkonem až 30 W na port Maximální spotřeba energie: 52.53 W (bez PD připojení), 485.4 W (s 384 W PD připojení) Rozměry: 17.3 × 13.0 × 1.7 in (440 × 330 × 44 mm) Výkon Přepínací kapacita: 104 Gbps Rychlost předávání paketů: 77.4 Mpps MAC Address Table: 16 K Packet Buffer Memory: 12 Mbit Jumbo Frame: 9 KB Software Podporuje 8 prioritních front, 802.1p CoS/DSCP prioritu, linkovou agregaci, Spanning Tree Protocol, Flow Control, Mirroring a mnoho dalších. Certifikace CE, FCC, RoHS Obsah balení TL-SG3452P Switch Napájecí kabel Rychlý průvodce instalací Sada pro montáž do racku Gumové nožičky Požadavky na systém Microsoft Windows 98SE, NT, 2000, XP, Vista™ nebo Windows 7/8/10/11, MAC OS, NetWare, UNIX nebo Linux. Provozní podmínky Provozní teplota: 0–40 °C (32–104 °F); Skladovací teplota: -40–70 °C (-40–158 °F); Provozní vlhkost: 10–90% RH bez kondenzace; Skladovací vlhkost: 5–90% RH bez kondenzace. (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako TP-Link OMADA JetStream switch TL-SG3452P (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48x PoE+, 384W, 2xconsole)

TP-Link OMADA JetStream switch TL-SG3452XP (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, 48x PoE+, 500W, 2xconsole)

Detail

TP-Link JetStream TL-SG3452XP EAN: 6935364006495 Síťový switch TP-Link JetStream TL-SG3452XP nabízí 48 gigabitových portů a 4 sloty SFP+ pro rychlé a efektivní připojení. 10G připojení Čtyři sloty SFP+ s rychlostí 10 Gbit/s umožňují vysoce propustné širokopásmové připojení. PoE+ napájení 48 gigabitových portů podporuje standardy 802.3af/at a PoE+ napájení s výstupním výkonem 500 W. Cloudová správa Integrace s platformou Omada SDN umožňuje cloudový přístup a vzdálenou správu. Funkce L2 a L2+ Switch podporuje kompletní sadu L2 a L2+ funkcí včetně statického směrování, QoS na podnikové úrovni a IGMP Snooping. Bezpečnostní strategie Integrované funkce jako vázání na IP-MAC-Port, ACL, zabezpečení portů a ověřování 802.1X zajišťují robustní bezpečnost. Samostatná správa Webové rozhraní, CLI, SNMP, RMON a Dual Image přináší komplexní možnosti správy. Technické specifikace Interface: 48× 10/100/1000 Mbps RJ45 PoE+ Ports, 4× 10G SFP+ Slots, 1× RJ45 Console Port, 1× Micro-USB Console Port Fan Quantity: 3 Power Supply: 100-240 V AC 50/60 Hz Dimensions: 17.3 × 13.0 × 1.7 in (440 × 330 × 44 mm) Mounting: Rack Mountable Pro více informací navštivte stránky produktu: https://www.tp-link.com/cz/business-networking/omada-sdn-switch/tl-sg3452xp/ (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako TP-Link OMADA JetStream switch TL-SG3452XP (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, 48x PoE+, 500W, 2xconsole)

Cisco switch CBS220-48P-4G, 48xGbE RJ45, 4xSFP, PoE+, 382W

Cisco switch CBS220-48P-4G, 48xGbE RJ45, 4xSFP, PoE+, 382W
Detail

Cisco CBS220-48P-4G Business 220 Series Smart Switches Jednoduchost a dostupnost Podnikové switche jsou základní součástí každé sítě. Společnost Cisco nabízí rozsáhlé portfolio síťových přepínačů pro malé firmy, využitelné v každé fázi Vašeho podnikání. Řada Cisco Business 220 jsou cenově dostupné smart switche se snadným používáním, zabezpečením a spolehlivostí pro sítě podnikové třídy. Zařízení se vyznačují hlavně díky intuitivnímu ovládacímu panelu, možnostem napájení přes PoE nebo přizpůsobitelným funkcím. Stránky produktu: CBS220-48P-4G Administration guide (pdf): Administration guide (pdf) Technické specifikace: Počet portů 52 Provedení Rack-mount Porty 48 x GbE RJ45, 4 x SFP, PoE+ Výkon Switching capacity: 104 Gbps Forwarding performance (64-byte packet size): 74.38 Mpps VLAN Ano Protokol pro vzdálenou správu SNMP, RMON, HTTP, HTTPS, TFTP, Telnet, SSH, BOOTP Standardy IEEE 802.3, IEEE 802.3u, IEEE 802.3ab, IEEE 802.3ad, 802.3z, IEEE 802.3x, IEEE 802.1D, IEEE 802.1Q/p, IEEE 802.1w, IEEE 802.1s, IEEE 802.1X, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at Velikost MAC tabulky 8 192 RAM 256 MB Flash 64 MB Napájení 100-240 V, 50-60 Hz, interní Rozměry (Š x V x H) 440 x 257 x 44 mm Hmotnost 5.29 kg Provozní teplota 0 až 50°C Provozní vlhost 10 - 90% Skladovací teplota -20 až 70 °C (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS220-48P-4G, 48xGbE RJ45, 4xSFP, PoE+, 382W

Netgear 8P GE SMART MANAGED PRO SWITCH, GS108T-300PES

Netgear 8P GE SMART MANAGED PRO SWITCH, GS108T-300PES
Detail

Jako přední poskytovatel síťových zařízení pro malé a střední podniky si společnost NETGEAR uvědomuje, že je důležité poskytovat velký výběr počtů portů a portů PoE, které se mohou přizpůsobit potřebám podniku, ať už v oblasti pohostinství, stravování, vzdělávání nebo maloobchodu. Proto společnost NETGEAR uvedla tento nový 8-portový switch Gigabit Smart Managed Pro. 8-portové switche Gigabit Smart Managed Pro Pro GS108Tv3 poskytují velkou hodnotu díky konfigurovatelným síťovým funkcím L2. Pokročilé funkce, jako je statické směrování vrstvy 3, správa IPv6, ACL, DiffServ QoS, agregace propojení LACP a Spanning Tree uspokojí i ty nejpokročilejší sítě malých podniků. Možnost vzdálené správy prostřednictvím nástroje NETGEAR Insight: https://www.atcomp.cz/downloads/vyrobce/netgear/PrepinaceNetgearSmartManagedPro_VzdalenaSpravaInsight.pdf Pro vzdálenou správu na jakémkoli zařízení / kdekoli / kdykoli prostřednictvím intuitivní aplikace nebo cloudového portálu. Technické parametry *Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 (10M/100M/1G)-1000BASE-T: 8 *Napájení: Externí DC 12V 1.0A *Zámek Kensington: Ano (zadní) *CPU: 500MHz jednojádrové, 128 MB RAM, 32 MB SPI FLASH *Paměť vyrovnávací paměti paketů: 512 kB *Režimy přesměrování: Ukládání a přeposílání *Šířka pásma (neblokující, full duplex): 16 Gb/s *Prioritní fronty: 8 *Fronta priority: Weighted Round Robin (WRR) and Strict Priority *Velikost databáze MAC adres (48bitové adresy MAC): 8 kB *Multicastové skupiny: 256 *Počet statických tras IPv4: 32 *Počet VLAN: 64 *Počet vazeb DHCP snoopingu: 256 *Access Control Lists (ACLs): 100 sdílených pro ACL MAC, IP a IPv6 *Rozměry (Š x H x V): 158 x 101 x 27 mm *Hmotnost: 0,43 kg Odkaz na web výrobce: https://www.netgear.com/images/datasheet/switches/SmartSwitches/GS108Tv3_GS110TPv3.pdf (patro.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Netgear 8P GE SMART MANAGED PRO SWITCH, GS108T-300PES

Zyxel GS1900-24Ev2, 24-port Desktop Gigabit Web Smart switch: 24x Gigabit metal, IPv6, 802.3az (Green), GS1900-24E-EU0102F

Zyxel GS1900-24Ev2, 24-port Desktop Gigabit Web Smart switch: 24x Gigabit metal, IPv6, 802.3az (Green), GS1900-24E-EU0102F
Detail

ZyXEL GS1900-24E 24-port Desktop Gigabit Web Smart switch: 24x Gigabit metal, IPv6, 802.3az (Green), Easy set up wizard, fanless, 19" rackmount kit PŘEHLED ZyXEL GS1900 řady 8/16/24-port GbE Smarta řiditelný přepínač s rychlostí Gigabit a základními řídícími funkcemi přináší větší flexibilitu a konektivitu. 1900 Series se skládá ze čtyř (4) modelů - GS1900-8, GS1900- 8 HP, GS1900-16 a GS1900-24E. Poskytování GbE pro stolní přepínače s energeticky úspornými funkcemi, design bez větráku a kompletní podporu IPv6 zajistí vaši síť, aby byla připravena na budoucí rozšíření. GS1900 série byla navržena s užitečnými funkcemi a pokročilým nastavením, které zajišťují rychlost a bezpečnost, jakož i tichý provoz v kancelářském prostředí. • 10/100/1000 Mb porty GbE • Snadný management skrze webový prohlížeč • Rychlý a snadný průvodce nastavením • Pokročilé síťové funkce a prevence chyb (smyčka ochrana, dvojité obrazy, storm control, DoS a SSL) • Provedení bez větráku • Green Ethernet IEEE 802.3az podpora SPECIFIKACE PORT DENSITY 10/100/1000 BASE-T,fixed • 24 10/100/1000 BASE-T, PoE, fixed • - SFP 100/1000 Mbps • - PERFORMANCE Switching capacity (Gbps) • 48 Switch forwarding rate (Mpps) • 35.7 Packet buffer (byte) • 525 K MAC address • 8 K Jumbo frame (byte) • 9 K POWER Input voltage of AC • 100 - 240 V AC, 50/60 Hz Max. power consumption (watt) • 14.6 PoE power budget (watt) • - PHYSICAL SPECIFICATIONS Item Dimensions (WxDxH) (mm) • 267 x 162 x 42 Item Weight (kg) • 1.56 Packing Dimensions (WxDxH) (mm) • 325 x 223 x 71 Packing Weight (kg) • 2.05 ENVIRONMENTAL SPECIFICATIONS Operating temperature • 0°C to 50°C Storage temperature • -40°C to 70°C Operating humidity • 10% to 95% (non-condensing) MTBF (hr) • 804,714 Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) • 49.79 (patro.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Zyxel GS1900-24Ev2, 24-port Desktop Gigabit Web Smart switch: 24x Gigabit metal, IPv6, 802.3az (Green), GS1900-24E-EU0102F

Zyxel GS1900-24E 24-port Desktop Gigabit Web Smart switch: 24x Gigabit metal, IPv6, 802.3az (Green), fanless, rack kit

Zyxel GS1900-24E 24-port Desktop Gigabit Web Smart switch: 24x Gigabit metal, IPv6, 802.3az (Green), fanless, rack kit
Detail

Zyxel GS1900-24E 24-port Desktop Gigabit Web Smart switch Produktové číslo: 4718937621132 Hlavní vlastnosti 24x GbE porty: 10/100/1000 Mbps pro rychlé a stabilní připojení. Jednoduchá správa: Přehledné webové rozhraní pro jednoduchou správu. Průvodce nastavením: Intuitivní průvodce pro snadné nastavení. Pokročilé funkce: Detekce síťových smyček, podpora dvou image souborů, storm control, DoS a SSL pro spolehlivou síť. Ekologické funkce Podpora ekologického standardu Ethernet IEEE 802.3az a inteligentní ekologické funkce ZyXEL pro úsporu energie. Provedení Bez ventilátoru pro tichý provoz. Rychlá a snadná montáž díky 19" rackmount kit. Flexibilita a výkon Řada GS1900 nabízí různé modely pro různé potřeby. Vysoký výkon a tichý provoz pro kanceláře. GS1900-8HP model Podpora standardu IEEE 802.3at PoE Plus s 8 porty s výkonem až 30W na jeden port. Ideální pro připojení zařízení s vyšší spotřebou. Jednoduchá správa pro spolehlivou síť Pokročilé funkce pro správu sítě: detekce síťových smyček, dva image soubory pro zálohu firmwaru, storm control pro efektivitu sítě, DoS pro ochranu sítě a SSL pro zabezpečení přenosových rámců. Ekologické funkce podle IEEE 802.3az Podpora standardu IEEE 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet (EEE) a další inovativní ekologické funkce ZyXEL pro snížení spotřeby zařízení. (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Zyxel GS1900-24E 24-port Desktop Gigabit Web Smart switch: 24x Gigabit metal, IPv6, 802.3az (Green), fanless, rack kit

TP-Link switch TL-SG1048 (48xGbE)

TP-Link switch TL-SG1048 (48xGbE)
Detail

TP-Link switch TL-SG1048 EAN: 6935364021559 Popis produktu TP-Link switch TL-SG1048 je 48portový gigabitový přepínač. Splňuje nejnáročnější požadavky na konektivitu. Vyznačuje se spolehlivostí a jednoduchou správou. Technické specifikace Standardy a protokoly: IEEE 802.3i, IEEE 802.3u, IEEE 802.3ab, IEEE 802.3x Rozhraní: 48 10/100/1000Mbps RJ45 Ports (Auto Negotiation/Auto MDI/MDIX) Síťové médium: 10BASE-T: UTP category 3, 4, 5 cable (maximum 100m), 100BASE-TX/1000BASE-T: UTP category 5, 5e or above cable (maximum 100m) Počet ventilátorů: 2 Zdroj napájení: 100-240VAC, 50/60Hz Spotřeba energie: Maximum: 29.8W (220V/50Hz) Rozměry: 17.32*8.7*1.73 in.(440*220*44 mm) Montáž: Rack Mountable Max. spotřeba energie: 32.29W(220V/50Hz) Max. výkon: 110.17BTU/h Výkon Přepínací kapacita: 96Gbps Rychlost předávání paketů: 71.4Mpps Tabulka MAC adres: 8K Velikost bufferu: 16Mb Jumbo Frame: 10KB Přenosová metoda: Store-and-Forward Další informace Certifikace: FCC, CE, RoHS Obsah balení: 48-Port Gigabit Rackmount Switch, napájecí kabel, instalační průvodce, montážní sada, pryžové nohy Provozní podmínky: Teplota: 0°C 40°C, vlhkost: 10% 90% non-condensing Skladovací podmínky: Teplota: -40°C 70°C, vlhkost: 5% 90% non-condensing (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako TP-Link switch TL-SG1048 (48xGbE)

Zyxel GS1900-8HP v3 8-port Desktop Gigabit Web Smart PoE switch: 8x Gigabit metal, IPv6, PoE budget 70W, fanless

Zyxel GS1900-8HP v3 8-port Desktop Gigabit Web Smart PoE switch: 8x Gigabit metal, IPv6, PoE budget 70W, fanless
Detail

Zyxel GS1900-8HP v3 8-port Desktop Gigabit Web Smart PoE switch EAN produktu: 4718937621279 Technické specifikace: 8x Gigabit metal IPv6 PoE budget 70W Fanless Detaily produktu: Switch disponuje 8 GbE porty s rychlostí 10/100/1000 Mbps. Pro jednoduchou správu je vybaven webovým rozhraním. Obsahuje průvodce nastavením pro snadné ovládání. Switch je vybaven detekcí síťových smyček. Podporuje dvě image soubory, storm control, DoS a SSL. Je navržen bez ventilátoru pro tichý chod. Podporuje ekologický standard Ethernet IEEE 802.3az a inteligentní ekologické funkce ZyXEL. PoE s vysokým výkonem podle IEEE 802.3at. Switch je vybaven 8mi 10/100/1000 Base -T ethernetovými porty s automatickou detekcí pro každý port MDI-II/MDI-X. Propustnost dosahuje hodnoty až 16Gbps, forwardovací rychlost 11.9 Mpps. Disponuje vyrovnávací paketovou pamětí o velikosti 525 bytů. Obsahuje 8 zabudovaných PoE Plus injektorů s celkovým výkonem až 70W (max. 30W na jeden port - PoE Plus). Provedení je wall mount. Rozměry switchu jsou 302x227x64 mm. Hmotnost produktu je 0,72kg. Maximální spotřeba energie je 84,3W. (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Zyxel GS1900-8HP v3 8-port Desktop Gigabit Web Smart PoE switch: 8x Gigabit metal, IPv6, PoE budget 70W, fanless

TP-Link OMADA JetStream switch TL-SG3428XF (20xSFP, 4xGbE/4xSFP combo, 4xSFP+, 2xconsole)

TP-Link OMADA JetStream switch TL-SG3428XF (20xSFP, 4xGbE/4xSFP combo, 4xSFP+, 2xconsole)
Detail

TP-Link TL-SG3428XF JetStream 24-Port SFP L2+ Managed Switch se 4 10GE SFP+ Sloty Bleskurychlé odchozí připojení 10G - 4 sloty SFP+ s rychlostí 10 Gbit/s umožňují vysoce propustné širokopásmové připojení a přepínací kapacitu bez blokování. Gigabitové rychlosti - 20 gigabitových portů SFP a 4 gigabitové kombinované porty SFP/RJ45 nabízí vysokorychlostní a spolehlivé spojení s dalšími switchi a zařízeními. Integrováno do platformy Omada SDN - Funkce ZTP (Zero-Touch Provisioning), centralizovaná cloudová správa a inteligentní monitorování. Centralizovaná správa - Cloudový přístup a aplikace Omada pro maximální pohodlí a snadnou správu. Statické směrování - Pomáhá směrovat tok dat po lokální síti, čímž zajišťuje efektivní využívání síťových prostředků. Robustní strategie zabezpečení - Funkce vázání na adresu IP-MAC, ACL, zabezpečení portů, ochrana proti útokům DoS, funkce Storm Control, funkce DHCP Snooping, ověřování protokolem 802.1X a Radius a další funkce. Optimalizovaný přenos hlasu a videa v aplikacích - L2/L3/L4 QoS a funkce IGMP Snooping. Samostatná správa - Webové rozhraní, CLI (konzolový port, Telnet, SSH), SNMP, RMON a funkce Dual Image přináší pokročilé možnosti správy. Stránky produktu: https://www.tp-link.com/cz/business-networking/managed-switch/tl-sg3428xf/ Technické specifikace HARDWARE FEATURES Interface • 20× Gigabit SFP Ports• 4× Gigabit SFP/RJ45 Combo Ports• 4× 10G SFP+ Slots• 1× RJ45 Console Port• 1× Micro-USB Console Port Fan Quantity 1 Fan Power Supply Dual Reduant Power Supplies100-240 V AC 50/60 Hz Dimensions (WxDxH) 17.3 × 8.7 × 1.7 in (440 × 220 × 44 mm) Mounting Rack Mountable Max Power Consumption 35.7 W (110 V/60 Hz) Max Heat Dissipation 121.81 BTU/hr (110 V/60 Hz) PERFORMANCE Switching Capacity 128 Gbps Packet Forwarding Rate 95.23 Mpps MAC Address Table 16 K Packet Buffer Memory 12 Mbit Jumbo Frame 9 KB SOFTWARE FEATURES Quality of Service • 8 priority queues• 802.1p CoS/DSCP priority• Queue scheduling- SP (Strict Priority)- WRR (Weighted Round Robin)- SP+WRR• Bandwidth Control- Port/Flow based Rating Limiting• Smoother Performance• Action for Flows- Mirror (to supported interface)- Redirect (to supported interface)- Rate Limit- QoS Remark L2 and L2+ Features • Link Aggregation- static link aggregation- 802.3ad LACP- Up to 8 aggregation groups, containing 8 ports per group• Spanning Tree Protocol- 802.1d STP- 802.1w RSTP- 802.1s MSTP- STP Security: TC Protect, BPDU Filter, Root Protect• Loopback Detection- Port based- VLAN based• Flow Control- 802.3x Flow Control- HOL Blocking Prevention• Mirroring- Port Mirroring- CPU Mirroring- One-to-One- Many-to-One- Tx/Rx/Both L2 Multicast • IGMP Snooping- IGMP v1/v2/v3 Snooping- Fast Leave- IGMP Snooping Querier- IGMP Authentication• IGMP Authentication• MLD Snooping- MLD v1/v2 Snooping- Fast Leave- MLD Snooping Querier- Static Group Config- Limited IP Multicast• MVR• Multicast Filtering: 256 profiles and 16 entries per profile VLAN • VLAN Group- Max 4K VLAN Groups• 802.1Q Tagged VLAN• MAC VLAN: 30 Entries• Protocol VLAN: Protocol Template 16, Protocol VLAN 16• Private VLAN• GVRP• VLAN VPN (QinQ)- Port-Based QinQ- Selective QinQ• Voice VLAN Access Control List • Time-based ACL• MAC ACL- Source MAC- Destination MAC- VLAN ID- User Priority- Ether Type• IP ACL-Source IP- Destination IP- Fragment- IP Protocol- TCP Flag- TCP/UDP Port- DSCP/IP TOS- User Priority• Combined ACL• Packet Content ACL• IPv6 ACL• Policy- Mirroring- Redirect- Rate Limit- QoS Remark• ACL apply to Port/VLAN Security • IP-MAC-Port Binding- 512 Entries- DHCP Snooping- ARP Inspection- IPv4 Source Guard: 100 Entries• IPv6-MAC-Port Binding- 512 Entries- DHCPv6 Snooping- ND Detection- IPv6 Source Guard: 100 Entries• DoS Defend• Static/Dynamic Port Security- Up to 64 MAC addresses per port• Broadcast/Multicast/Unicast Storm Control- kbps/ratio control mode• 802.1X- Port base authentication- Mac base authentication- VLAN Assignment- MAB- Guest VLAN- Support Radius authentication andaccountability• AAA (including TACACS+)• Port Isolation• Secure web management through HTTPS with SSLv3/TLS 1.2• Secure Command Line Interface (CLI) management with SSHv1/SSHv2• IP/Port/MAC based access control IPv6 • IPv6 Dual IPv4/IPv6• Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD) Snooping• IPv6 ACL• IPv6 Interface• Static IPv6 Routing• IPv6 neighbor discovery (ND)• Path maximum transmission unit (MTU) discovery• Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) version 6• TCPv6/UDPv6• IPv6 applications- DHCPv6 Client- Ping6- Tracert6- Telnet (v6)- IPv6 SNMP- IPv6 SSH- IPv6 SSL- Http/Https- IPv6 TFTP L3 Features • 16 IPv4/IPv6 Interfaces• Static Routing- 48 static routes• Static ARP- 128 Static Entries• Proxy ARP• Gratuitous ARP• DHCP Server• DHCP Relay- DHCP Interface Relay- DHCP VLAN Relay• DHCP L2 Relay Advanced Features • Automatic Device Discovery• Batch Configuration• Batch Firmware Upgrading• Intelligent Network Monitoring• Abnormal Event Warnings• Unified Configuration• Reboot Schedule MIBs • MIB II (RFC1213)• Interface MIB (RFC2233)• Ethernet Interface MIB (RFC1643)• Bridge MIB (RFC1493)• P/Q-Bridge MIB (RFC2674)• RMON MIB (RFC2819)• RMON2 MIB (RFC2021)• Radius Accounting Client MIB (RFC2620)• Radius Authentication Client MIB (RFC2618)• Remote Ping, Traceroute MIB (RFC2925)• Support TP-Link private MIB MANAGEMENT Omada App Yes. Requiring the use of OC300, OC200, Omada Cloud-Based Controller, or Omada Software Controller. Centralized Management • Omada Cloud-Based Controller• Omada Hardware Controller (OC300)• Omada Hardware Controller (OC200)• Omada Software Controlle Cloud Access Yes. Requiring the use of OC300, OC200, Omada Cloud-Based Controller, or Omada Software Controller. Zero-Touch Provisioning Yes. Requiring the use of Omada Cloud-Based Controller. Management Features • Web-based GUI• Command Line Interface (CLI) through the console port, telnet• SNMP v1/v2c/v3- Trap/Inform- RMON (1,2,3,9 groups)• SDM Template• DHCP/BOOTP Client• 802.1ab LLDP/LLDP-MED• DHCP AutoInstall• Dual Image, Dual Configuration• CPU Monitoring• Cable Diagnostics• EEE• Password Recovery• SNTP• System Log OTHERS Certification CE, FCC, RoHS Package Contents • TL-SG3428XF Switch• Power Cord• Quick Installation Guide• Rackmount Kit• Rubber Feet System Requirements Microsoft Windows 98SE, NT, 2000, XP, Vista™ or Windows 7/8/10/11, MAC OS, NetWare, UNIX or Linux. Environment • Operating Temperature: 0–45 ? (32–113 ?);• Storage Temperature: -40–70 ? (-40–158 ?)• Operating Humidity: 10–90% RH non-condensing• Storage Humidity: 5–90% RH non-condensing (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako TP-Link OMADA JetStream switch TL-SG3428XF (20xSFP, 4xGbE/4xSFP combo, 4xSFP+, 2xconsole)

Síťový switch NETGEAR, GS605, 5 portů

Detail

1x síťový switch GS605 400 PES Dual-Band·1x napájecí zdroj·1x návod. (conrad.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Síťový switch NETGEAR, GS605, 5 portů

Síťový switch NETGEAR, GS105GE, 5 portů

Detail

Automatické rozpoznání (Auto-MDI/MDIX) ·Pro přenos dat rychlostí až 1000 MBit/s ·5 portů pro větší flexibilitu pro další síťová zařízení·Provoz bez hluku , protože bez ventilátoru 2x přepínač·2x napájecí adaptér·. (conrad.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Síťový switch NETGEAR, GS105GE, 5 portů

Síťový switch NETGEAR, GS205, 5 portů

Detail

Gigabit Ethernet pro rychlé vypalovačky Přepínač·Síťový zdroj·. (conrad.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Síťový switch NETGEAR, GS205, 5 portů

Síťový switch NETGEAR, GS208, 8 portů

Detail

Gigabit Ethernet pro rychlé vypalovačky Přepínač·Síťový zdroj·. (conrad.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Síťový switch NETGEAR, GS208, 8 portů

Switch Netgear Gigabit GS105, 5-portový

Switch Netgear Gigabit GS105, 5-portový
Detail

U těchto switchů se jedná o vysoce výkonné Gigabitové měděné přepínače. Umožňují jednoduše vylepšit existující sítě na přenosovou rychlost 1000 MBit/s - přes CAT 5. Mohou však být nasazeny i v obvyklých sítích Fast-Ethernet stejně jako v 1000 MBit/s sítích Gigabit a jsou vhodné jako desktopové přístroje, neboť neobsahují ventilátor a jsou tedy bezhlučné. Automatické rozpoznání (Auto-MDI/MDIX) ·Pro přenos dat rychlostí až 1000 MBit/s ·5 portů pro větší flexibilitu pro další síťová zařízení·Provoz bez hluku , protože bez ventilátoru Přepínač·Síťový zdroj·. (conrad.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Switch Netgear Gigabit GS105, 5-portový

Switch Netgear Gigabit GS108, 8-portový

Switch Netgear Gigabit GS108, 8-portový
Detail

U těchto switchů se jedná o vysoce výkonné Gigabitové měděné přepínače. Umožňují jednoduše vylepšit existující sítě na přenosovou rychlost 1000 MBit/s. Jsou obzvláště vhodné jako desktopové přístroje, neboť neobsahují ventilátor a jsou tedy bezhlučné. Automatické rozpoznání (Auto-MDI/MDIX) ·Pro přenos dat rychlostí až 1000 MBit/s ·8 portů pro větší flexibilitu pro další síťová zařízení·Provoz bez hluku , protože bez ventilátoru (conrad.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Switch Netgear Gigabit GS108, 8-portový

Switch Netgear Gigabit GS116, 16-portový

Switch Netgear Gigabit GS116, 16-portový
Detail

U těchto switchů se jedná o vysoce výkonné Gigabitové měděné přepínače. Umožňují jednoduše vylepšit existující sítě na přenosovou rychlost 1000 MBit/s. Jsou obzvláště vhodné jako desktopové přístroje, neboť neobsahují ventilátor a jsou tedy bezhlučné. High speed s Ethernet 10/100/1000 MBit/s a auto sensing·Integrovaný zařízení s 10, 100 a 1000 MBit/s v jedné síti·Pracuje zcela bez hluku a je díky malé rozměry ideální pro použití na pracovišti vhodné (conrad.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Switch Netgear Gigabit GS116, 16-portový

Netgear GBIC 1000Base-ZX SFP switch

Netgear GBIC 1000Base-ZX SFP switch
Detail

Kompatibilní k FS726T, FS726TP, FS750T2, GS716T, GS724T, GS748T, FSM7326P, FSM7328S, FSM7352S, GSM7212, GSM7224, GSM7248, GSM7312, GSM7324. Pracuje s 50 a 62,5 a 9 µm single mode-kabelem. (conrad.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Netgear GBIC 1000Base-ZX SFP switch

Síťový switch NETGEAR, GS105E, 5 portů

Detail

Vložte GS105E jako Plug-and-play switch nebo využijte konfigurační utility pro snadné nastavení·Podporuje síťové monitoring, Traffic-Priorisierung a virtuální síťový skupin·Zelený sítí pro snížení spotřeby energie·5 porty poskytují až 2000 Mbit/s obousměrné pásma na každý port·Quality of Service (QoS) pro slouží jako prioritní rozdělovač na Netzwerk-Traffics·Virtual LAN (VLAN) Support pro Netzwerk-Segmentierung a bezpečnost ProSafe Gigabit Ethernet switch·Nástěnný montážní sada·Napájecí zdroj 12 V / 1.0A·Instalační CD s konfiguračním Utility software ·Průvodce rychlým nastavením. (conrad.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Síťový switch NETGEAR, GS105E, 5 portů

NETGEAR S350 Series 8-port Gigabit PoE+ Ethernet Smart Managed Pro Switch with 2 SFP Ports, GS310TP, GS310TP-100EUS

NETGEAR S350 Series 8-port Gigabit PoE+ Ethernet Smart Managed Pro Switch with 2 SFP Ports, GS310TP, GS310TP-100EUS
Detail

NETGEAR GS310TP Osmiportový gigabitový ethernetový přepínač PoE+ řady Smart Managed Pro S350 se dvěmi SFP porty Odkaz na web výrobce: https://www.netgear.com/business/products/switches/smart/GS310TP.aspx Funkce Malé a střední firmy se v současné době velmi často potýkají s nárůstem virtualizace a zvýšeným počtem cloudových služeb a aplikací, jako je VoIP, streamování videa či sledování IP. Ty nejen zvyšují nároky na spolehlivost firemních sítí, ale zároveň i na jejich výkon a bezpečnost. Řada přepínačů NETGEAR Smart Managed Pro S350 na tyto základní síťové potřeby reaguje aktivně a nabízí tak unikátní neblokovanou šířku pásma o velikosti jednoho gigabitu i vynikající bezpečnost sítě za dostupnou cenu. Model NETGEAR GS310TP je vybaven osmi gigabitovými ethernetovými porty PoE+ s celkovým budgetem 55 W, dvěma porty SFP sloužícími pro uplink a širokou řadou pokročilých konfigurovatelných funkcí ve vrstvě L2, jako je L2/L3/L4 ACL (Access Control Lists), QoS, LACP (Link Aggregation Control Protocol), STP (Spanning Tree Protocol) či IGMP Snooping, jež zajišťují rychlý přenos dat a špičkové zabezpečení. Vysokou bezpečnost zařízení dále poskytují funkce automatické DoS prevence, 802.1x ověření, DHCP filtrování či ACL filtrování. Přepínač lze snadno instalovat a spravovat prostřednictvím intuitivního uživatelského webového rozhraní (GUI) a nástrojů Smart Control Center a Network Management System. Flexibilní umístění přepínače GS310TP umožňují speciální úchytky, díky nimž ho lze připevnit na stěnu, stůl či pod jeho spodní hranu. Tichý chod zajišťuje bezvětrákové provedení. Vlastnosti *Osm gigabitových ethernetových portů PoE+ a dva porty SFP pro uplink. *Pokročilé funkce ve vrstvě L2. *Vysoce kvalitní zabezpečení. *Snadná správa prostřednictvím webového rozhraní. *Možnost umístění zařízení na stěnu či volně na stůl. *Provedení bez větráku zajišťující tichý provoz. OBSAH BALENÍ *S350 Series 8-port Gigabit PoE+ Ethernet Smart Managed Pro Switch with 2 SFP Ports (GS310TP) *Power Adapter *Power cord (varies by region) *Installation guide SPECIFIKACE Technické vlastnosti Počet gigabitových portů: *8 Z toho PoE/PoE+ portů: *8 PoE budget *55 W Počet SFP portů *2 Počet napájecích USB portů *0 Maximální počet MAC záznamů *8 000 Velikost vyrovnávací paměti *512 KB VLAN *64 VLAN routing *ne Podporované skupiny pro multicast komunikaci *256 IGMP Snooping *ano ACL *100 Host ARP table *ano EEE *ano Denial-of-Service prevence *ano Interní/externí dodávka energie *externí, 54 V, 1,25 A Maximální spotřeba *15,1 W bez PoE, 69,3 W s PoE Počet větráků *0 Provozní teplota *0 až 40 °C Rozměry *236 x 101 x 30 mm Hmotnost *610 g Pro více informací navštivte web výrobce. (patro.cz)

Podobné produkty ako NETGEAR S350 Series 8-port Gigabit PoE+ Ethernet Smart Managed Pro Switch with 2 SFP Ports, GS310TP, GS310TP-100EUS

Cisco switch CBS220-24T-4G (24xGbE, 4xSFP, fanless)

Cisco switch CBS220-24T-4G (24xGbE, 4xSFP, fanless)
Detail

Cisco switch CBS220-24T-4G Výkon a spolehlivost přináší tento smart switch od společnosti Cisco. Je určen pro malé a střední firmy, které vyžadují kvalitní a efektivní řešení pro své podnikové sítě. Design a konstrukce Switch je navržen pro montáž do racku. Je tichý, neboť nedisponuje ventilátorem. Rozměry zařízení jsou 440 x 203 x 44 mm a hmotnost 2.75 kg. Porty a výkon Cisco CBS220-24T-4G disponuje celkem 28 porty - 24x GbE RJ45 a 4x SFP. Jeho přepínací kapacita dosahuje až 56 Gbps a výkon je 41.66 Mpps při 64-byte packet size. Technické specifikace RAM: 256 MB Flash: 64 MB Počet MAC adres: až 8 192 VLAN: Ano Protokoly: SNMP, RMON, HTTP, HTTPS, TFTP, Telnet, SSH, BOOTP Standardy: IEEE 802.3, IEEE 802.3u, IEEE 802.3ab, IEEE 802.3ad, 802.3z, IEEE 802.3x, IEEE 802.1D, IEEE 802.1Q/p, IEEE 802.1w, IEEE 802.1s, IEEE 802.1X, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at Provozní podmínky Provozní teplota tohoto switchu je od 0 do 50°C a provozní vlhkost 10 - 90%. Skladovat jej můžete při teplotě -20 až 70°C. Zabezpečení Zabezpečení sítě je zajištěno pomocí rozsáhlých Acces Control Lists (ACL), které mohou omezit citlivé části sítě před neoprávněnými uživateli a chránit před síťovými útoky. EAN: 889728344807 (tonerpartner.cz)

Podobné produkty ako Cisco switch CBS220-24T-4G (24xGbE, 4xSFP, fanless)
Gosund Smart Switch SW9 (SW9), Naturehike ultralight Shared 2 20D (6927595749074), Sonoff ZigBee Smart Switch, ZBMINI (ZBMINI), Tesla Smart Switch (TSL-SWI-WIFI1), Tesla Smart Switch Dual (TSL-SWI-WIFI2), Tellur WiFi Smart Inline Switch, 2200W, bílý, MOES smart WIFI+RF433 switch (WS-EUB1), Tesla Smart Switch ZigBee (TSL-SWI-ZIGBEE1), AVELI STATIC WINGS (XRT-00069), Tesla Smart Switch Dual ZigBee (TSL-SWI-ZIGBEE2), Tesla Smart Switch Dual Battery (TSL-SWI-SCENEZG2), Tesla Smart Switch Quatro Battery (TSL-SWI-SCENEZG4), Netgear GS108GE (GS108GE), WENKO Static-Loc - Háček, lesklý (z21794100), SONOFF RFR2 - WIFI DIY Smart RF Control Switch (RFR2), MOES Hidden wifi smart Dimmer switch 2gang (MS-105b), MOES smart WIFI+RF433 switch (with neutral) (WS-EUB2), Immax NEO LITE Smart vypínač / switch 16A, WiFi (07731L), MOES smart WIFI Touch Dimmer switch (EDM-01AA-EU), MOES smart WIFI Rotary Dimmer Switch (EDM-01WAA-EU), MOES Hidden wifi smart switch 2 gang (MS-104B), MOES smart Bluetooth+ WIFI+RF433 switch (WS-EU2-RFW-N), MOES smart Bluetooth+ WIFI+RF433 switch (WS-EU3-RFW-N), Static Abyss: Labyrinth Of Veins - CD (0801056894625), iFixit Portable Anti-Static Mat (EU145202-5), MADCAT A-Static Clonk Teaser 150g (RYB014823nad), Netgear AXLC763 (AXLC763-10000S), Netgear GS308PP (GS308PP-100EUS), Netgear EX6130 (EX6130-100PES), Netgear A6210 (A6210-100PES)